blob: 89dd4df25129d87102c1d742775477898b57046b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau71f95fa2020-01-22 10:34:58 +01007 2020/01/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100614 - presetenv
615 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - uid
617 - ulimit-n
618 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200619 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100620 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200621 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-options
625 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200627 - ssl-default-server-options
628 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100629 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100630 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100631 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100632 - 51degrees-data-file
633 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200634 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200635 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200636 - wurfl-data-file
637 - wurfl-information-list
638 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100640 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100643 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200644 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200646 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100647 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100648 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200650 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200651 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200652 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200653 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654 - noepoll
655 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000656 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100658 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300659 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000660 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100661 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200662 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200663 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200664 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000665 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000666 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200667 - tune.buffers.limit
668 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200669 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200670 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100671 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200672 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200673 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200674 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100675 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200676 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200677 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100678 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100679 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100680 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100681 - tune.lua.session-timeout
682 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200683 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100684 - tune.maxaccept
685 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200686 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200687 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200688 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100689 - tune.rcvbuf.client
690 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100691 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200692 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100693 - tune.sndbuf.client
694 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100695 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100696 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200697 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100698 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200699 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200700 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100701 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200702 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100703 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200704 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
705 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
706 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100707 - tune.zlib.memlevel
708 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 * Debugging
711 - debug
712 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713
714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716------------------------------------
717
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200718ca-base <dir>
719 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200720 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
721 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723chroot <jail dir>
724 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
725 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
726 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
727 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
728 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100730
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100731cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
732 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
733 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
734 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
735 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
736 set. These sets have the format
737
738 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
739
740 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100741 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
743 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100744 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
745 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100747 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100749 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
751 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
752 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
753 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100754
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100755 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
756 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
757 on the machine's word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
761 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
762 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
763 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
764 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
765 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766
767 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
769
770 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
771 # first 4 CPUs
772
773 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
774 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
775 # word size.
776
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100777 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
781 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
782
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
784 # and so on.
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
787 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100789 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100790 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
791 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
792 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
793
794 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
795 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
796 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
797
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100798 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
799 # and a thread range.
800 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
802 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
803
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200804crt-base <dir>
805 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100806 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
807 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200808
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809daemon
810 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
811 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100812 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
813 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200815deviceatlas-json-file <path>
816 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100817 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200818
819deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100820 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200821 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
822
823deviceatlas-separator <char>
824 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
825 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
826
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100827deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200828 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
829 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
830 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100831
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900832external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100833 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
834 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100835 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
836 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
837 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
838 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
839 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841gid <number>
842 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
843 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
844 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100845 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
846 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100848
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100849group <group name>
850 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
851 See also "gid" and "user".
852
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100853hard-stop-after <time>
854 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
855
856 Arguments :
857 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
858 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
859 SIGUSR1 signal.
860
861 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
862 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
863 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
864
865 Example:
866 global
867 hard-stop-after 30s
868
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200869h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
870 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
871 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
872 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
873 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
874 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
875 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
876 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
877 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
878 specified in a proxy.
879
880 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
881 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
882 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
883 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
884 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
885 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
886 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
887
888 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
889 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
890 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
891 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
892 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
893
894 Example:
895 global
896 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
897
898 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
899 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
900
901h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
902 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
903 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
904 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
905 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
906 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
907 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
908 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
909 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
910
911 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
912 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
913 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
914
915 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
916 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
917
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100918insecure-fork-wanted
919 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
920 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
921 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
922 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
923 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
924 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
925 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
926 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
927 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
928 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
929 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
930 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
931 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
932 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
933 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
934 disable it.
935
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100936insecure-setuid-wanted
937 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
938 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
939 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
940 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
941 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
942 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
943 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
944 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
945 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
946 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
947 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
948 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
949 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
950 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
951
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200952log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
953 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100954 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100955 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100956 configured with "log global".
957
958 <address> can be one of:
959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100960 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100961 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
962 port).
963
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100964 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
965 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
966 port).
967
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100968 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100969 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
970 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100972
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100973 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
974 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
975 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
976 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
977 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
978 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
979 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
980 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
981 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
982 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
983 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
984 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
985 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
986 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100987 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
988 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100989
990 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
991 "fd@2", see above.
992
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200993 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
994 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
995 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
996 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
997 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
998
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1000 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001001
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001002 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1003 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1004 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1005 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1006 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1007 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1008 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1009 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1010 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1011 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001012 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1013 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001014
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001015 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1016 one of the following :
1017
1018 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1019 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1020
1021 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1022 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1023
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001024 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1025 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1026 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1027 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1028 logger consumes.
1029
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001030 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1031 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1032 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1033 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1034
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001035 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1036 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1037 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1038 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1039 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1040
1041 <sample_size>
1042 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1043 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1044 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1045 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1046 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1047
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001048 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001050 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1051 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1052 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1053
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001054 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1055 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1056 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1057 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058
1059 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001060 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1061 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1062 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1063 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1064 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1065 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001067 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001069log-send-hostname [<string>]
1070 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1071 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1072 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1073 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1074 the logs.
1075
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001076log-tag <string>
1077 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1078 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1079 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001080 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001081
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001082lua-load <file>
1083 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1084 used multiple times.
1085
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001086lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1087 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1088 variable.
1089 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1090 to "path".
1091
1092 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1093 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1094 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1095 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1096 will be checked earlier.
1097
1098 As an example by specifying the following path:
1099
1100 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1101 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1102
1103 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1104 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1105 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1106 paths if that does not exist either.
1107
1108 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1109 documentation.
1110
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001111master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001112 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1113 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1114 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001115 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001116 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1117 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001118 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1119 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1120 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1121 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1122 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001123
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001124 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001125
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001126mworker-max-reloads <number>
1127 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001128 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001129 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1130 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1131 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133nbproc <number>
1134 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1135 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1136 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001137 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1138 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001139 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1140 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001142nbthread <number>
1143 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001144 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1145 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1146 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1147 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1148 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001149 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1150 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1151 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1152 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1153 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1154 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1155 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001156
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001158 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1160 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162presetenv <name> <value>
1163 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1164 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1165 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1166 and "unsetenv".
1167
1168resetenv [<name> ...]
1169 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1170 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1171 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1172 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1173 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1174 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1175 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1176 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1177
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001178stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001179 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1180 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1181 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1182 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1183 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1184 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001185 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001186 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1187 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1188 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1189 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001190
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001191server-state-base <directory>
1192 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001193 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1194 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001195
1196server-state-file <file>
1197 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1198 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1199 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1200 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1201 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1202 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1203 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1204 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001205 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1206 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001207
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001208setenv <name> <value>
1209 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1210 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1211 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1212 and "unsetenv".
1213
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001214set-dumpable
1215 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001216 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1217 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1218 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1219 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1220 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1221 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1222 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1223 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1224 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1225 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1226 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1227 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1228 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1229 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1230 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1231 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1232 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001233
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001234ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1235 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1236 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001237 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001238 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001239 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1240 information and recommendations see e.g.
1241 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1242 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1243 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1244 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001245
1246ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1248 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1249 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1250 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1251 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001252 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1253 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1254 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001255 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001256
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001257ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1259 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1260 keyword to see available options.
1261
1262 Example:
1263 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001264 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001265
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001266ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1268 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001269 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001270 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001271 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1272 information and recommendations see e.g.
1273 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1274 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1275 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1276 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1277 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1282 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1283 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1284 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1288 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1293 keyword to see available options.
1294
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1298 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001299 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001300 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001301 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1302 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1303 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1304 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001305 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1306 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1307 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1308
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001309ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1310 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1311 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1312 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1313
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001314stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1315 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1316 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1317 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001318 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001319 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001320
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001321 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1322 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1323 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001324
1325stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1326 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1327 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001328 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001329
1330stats maxconn <connections>
1331 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1332 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1333
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334uid <number>
1335 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1336 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1337 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1338 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1339
1340ulimit-n <number>
1341 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1342 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1343 option.
1344
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001345unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1346 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1347
1348 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1349 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1350 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1351 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1352 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1353 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1354 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1355 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1356 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1357 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1358
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001359unsetenv [<name> ...]
1360 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1361 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1362 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1363 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1364 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1365 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1366 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1367
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001368user <user name>
1369 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1370 See also "uid" and "group".
1371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001372node <name>
1373 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1374
1375 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1376 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1377 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1378 traffic.
1379
1380description <text>
1381 Add a text that describes the instance.
1382
1383 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1384 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1385 "<" and ">" characters.
1386
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100138751degrees-data-file <file path>
1388 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001389 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001390
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001391 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001392 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1393
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000139451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001395 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1396 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1397 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1398
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001399 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001400 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1401
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200140251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001403 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1404 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1405
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001406 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1407 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1408
140951degrees-cache-size <number>
1410 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1411 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1412 By default, this cache is disabled.
1413
1414 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001415 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1416
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001417wurfl-data-file <file path>
1418 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1419 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1420
1421 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1422 with USE_WURFL=1.
1423
1424wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1425 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1426 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1427 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1428
1429 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1430
1431 Valid WURFL properties are:
1432 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1433
1434 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1435 device.
1436
1437 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1438 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1439
1440 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1441 particular web request.
1442
1443 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1444 used Libwurfl API version.
1445
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001446 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1447 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1448
1449 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1450 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1451
1452 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1453
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001454 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1455 with USE_WURFL=1.
1456
1457wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1458 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1459 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1460
1461 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1462 with USE_WURFL=1.
1463
1464wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1465 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1466 thus before the chroot.
1467
1468 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1469 with USE_WURFL=1.
1470
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001471wurfl-cache-size <size>
1472 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1473 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001474 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001475 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001476
1477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1478 with USE_WURFL=1.
1479
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001480strict-limits
1481 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1482 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1483 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1484 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1485 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1486 keyword.
1487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014883.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001489-----------------------
1490
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001491busy-polling
1492 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1493 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1494 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1495 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1496 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1497 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1498 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1499 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1500 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1501 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1502 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1503 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1504 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1505 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1506 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1507 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1508 "poll" pollers.
1509
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001510 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1511 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1512 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1513
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001514max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1515 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1516 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1517 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1518 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1519 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1520 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1521 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1522 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1523
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001524maxconn <number>
1525 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1526 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1527 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001528 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1529 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1530 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1531 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001532 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1533 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1534 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1535 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1536 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1537 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001538
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001539maxconnrate <number>
1540 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1541 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1542 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1543 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1544 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1545 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1546 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1547 fairness.
1548
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001549maxcomprate <number>
1550 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001552 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1553 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1554 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001555 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001556 default value.
1557
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001558maxcompcpuusage <number>
1559 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1560 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1561 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1562 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1563 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1564 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1565 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1566 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1567
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001568maxpipes <number>
1569 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1570 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1571 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1572 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1573 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1574 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1575
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001576maxsessrate <number>
1577 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1578 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1579 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1580 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1581 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1582 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1583 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1584 fairness.
1585
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001586maxsslconn <number>
1587 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1588 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1589 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1590 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1591 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1592 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1593 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001594 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1595 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1596 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1597 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1598 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1599 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1600 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001601
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001602maxsslrate <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1604 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1605 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1606 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1607 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1608 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1609 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1610 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1611 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1612 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1613
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001614maxzlibmem <number>
1615 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1616 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1617 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001618 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1619 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1620 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001622noepoll
1623 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1624 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001625 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001626
1627nokqueue
1628 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1629 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1630 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1631
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001632noevports
1633 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1634 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1635 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1636 also "nopoll".
1637
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001638nopoll
1639 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1640 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001642 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1643 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001644
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001645nosplice
1646 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001648 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001649 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001650 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1651 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1652 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1653 "option splice-response".
1654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001655nogetaddrinfo
1656 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1657 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1658
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001659noreuseport
1660 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1661 command line argument "-dR".
1662
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001663profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1664 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1665 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1666 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1667 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001668 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001669 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1670 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1671 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1672 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1673
1674 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1675 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1676 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1677 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1678 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001679 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1680 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1681 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1682 CLI.
1683
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001684spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001685 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1686 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1687 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1688 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1689 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1690 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001692ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001693 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001694 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001695 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1696 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1697 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1698 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1699 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001700 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1701 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001702 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1703 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1704 openssl configuration file uses:
1705 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1706
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001707ssl-mode-async
1708 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001709 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001710 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1711 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1712 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001713 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001714 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001715
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001716tune.buffers.limit <number>
1717 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1718 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1719 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1720 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1721 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001722 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001723 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1724 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1725 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1726 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1727 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1728 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1729 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1730 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1731 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1732
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001733tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1734 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1735 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1736 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1737 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1738
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001739tune.bufsize <number>
1740 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1741 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1742 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1743 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1744 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1745 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1746 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001747 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1748 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1749 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001750 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001751 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1752 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1753 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001754
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001755tune.chksize <number>
1756 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1757 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1758 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1759 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1760 checks whenever possible.
1761
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001762tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1763 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1764 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1765 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1766 this value. The default value is 1.
1767
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001768tune.fail-alloc
1769 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1770 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1771 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1772 gracefully.
1773
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001774tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1775 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1776 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1777 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1778 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1779 change it.
1780
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001781tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1782 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1784 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001785 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1786 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1787 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1788 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1789 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1790
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001791tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1792 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1793 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1794 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1795 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1796 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1797 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1798 recommended not to change this value.
1799
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001800tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1801 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1802 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1803 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1804 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1805 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1806 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1807 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1808
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001809tune.http.cookielen <number>
1810 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1811 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1812 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1813 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1814 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1815 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1816 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1817 to change this value.
1818
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001819tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001820 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1821 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001822 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001824 configuration directives too.
1825 The default value is 1024.
1826
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001827tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1828 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1829 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1830 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1831 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1832 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1833 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001834 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1835 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1836 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001837
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001838tune.idletimer <timeout>
1839 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1840 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1841 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1842 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1843 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1844 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001845 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001846 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001847 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1848
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001849tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1850 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1851 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1852 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1853 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1854 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1855 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1856 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1857 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1858 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1859
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001860tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1861 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001862 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001863 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1864 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001866 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1867 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1868
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001869tune.lua.maxmem
1870 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1871 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1872 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1873 memory.
1874
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001875tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1876 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001877 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1878 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001879 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001880
1881tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1882 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1883 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1884 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1885 check servers.
1886
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001887tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1888 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1889 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1890 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001891 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001892
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001893tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001894 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1895 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1896 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1897 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1898 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1899 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1900 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1901 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1902 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1903 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001904
1905tune.maxpollevents <number>
1906 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1907 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1908 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1909 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1910 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1911
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001912tune.maxrewrite <number>
1913 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1914 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1915 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1916 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1917 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1918 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1919 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1920 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1921 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1922 bufsize.
1923
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001924tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1925 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1926 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1927 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1928 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1929 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1930 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1931 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1932 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1933 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001934 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1935 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001936 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1937 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1938 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1939 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1940 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1941 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1942 setting this parameter to 0.
1943
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001944tune.pipesize <number>
1945 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1946 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1947 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1948 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1949 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1950 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1951
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001952tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1953 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1954 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1955 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1956 default is 20.
1957
1958tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1959 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1960 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1961 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1962 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1963 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1964 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001965 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001966
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001967tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1968tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1969 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1970 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1971 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001972 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001973 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001974 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1975 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1976
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001977tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001978 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001979 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1980 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1981 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1982 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1983
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001984tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001985 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001986 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1987 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1988
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001989tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1990tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1991 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1992 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1993 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001994 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001995 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001996 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1997 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1998 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1999 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2000 notifying haproxy again.
2001
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002002tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002003 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2004 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2005 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002006 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002007 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002008 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002009 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2010 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2011 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002012 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2013 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002014
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002015tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002016 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002017 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2018 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2019 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2020 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2021 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2022
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002023tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2024 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002025 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002026 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2027 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2028 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2029 being used for too long.
2030
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002031tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2032 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2033 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2034 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2035 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2036 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2037 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2038 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2039 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2040 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2041 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002042 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002043 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002044
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002045tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2046 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2047 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2048 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2049 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2050 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2051 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2052 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002053 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2054 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002055
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002056tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2057 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2058 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2059 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2060 1000 entries.
2061
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002062tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2063 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2064 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2065 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2066
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002067tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002068tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002069tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2070tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2071tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002072 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2073 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2074 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2075 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2076 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2077 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2078 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2079 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002080
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002081 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2082 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2083 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2084 all available space is consumed.
2085 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2086 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2087 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002088
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002089tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2090 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002091 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002092 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002093 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002094 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2095
2096tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2097 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2098 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002099 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2100 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021023.3. Debugging
2103--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002104
2105debug
2106 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2107 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2108 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2109 system startup.
2110
2111quiet
2112 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2113 line argument "-q".
2114
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021163.4. Userlists
2117--------------
2118It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2119http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2120it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2121
2122userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002123 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002124 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2125
2126group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002127 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002128 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2129 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2130
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002131user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2132 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002133 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2134 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002135 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2136 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2137 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2138 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002139
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002140 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2141 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2142 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2143 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2144 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2145 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2146 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2147 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2148 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002149
2150 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002151 userlist L1
2152 group G1 users tiger,scott
2153 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002154
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002155 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2156 user scott insecure-password elgato
2157 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002158
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002159 userlist L2
2160 group G1
2161 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002162
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002163 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2164 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2165 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002166
2167 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002168
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002169
21703.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002171----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002172It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2173several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2174instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2175values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2176automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2177In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2178using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2179tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2180reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2181Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2182that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2183each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002184
2185peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002186 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002187 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2188
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002189bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2190 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2191 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2192
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002193disabled
2194 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2195 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2196 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2197
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002198default-bind [param*]
2199 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2200
2201default-server [param*]
2202 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2203
2204 Arguments:
2205 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2206 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2207 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2208 details.
2209
2210
2211 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2212
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002213enable
2214 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2215
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002216log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2217 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2218 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2219 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2220 more details.
2221
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002222peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002223 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2224 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2225 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2226 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2227 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2228 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2229
2230 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2231 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2232
2233 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2234 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2235 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2236 across all peers.
2237
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002238 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2239 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002240
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002241 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2242 "server" keyword explanation below).
2243
2244server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002245 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002246 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2247 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2248 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2249 of this "peers" section).
2250 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2251
2252
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002253 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002254 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002256 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2257 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2258 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002259
2260 backend mybackend
2261 mode tcp
2262 balance roundrobin
2263 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2264 stick on src
2265
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002266 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2267 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002268
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002269 Example:
2270 peers mypeers
2271 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2272 default-server ssl verify none
2273 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2274 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002275
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002276
2277table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2278 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2279
2280 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2281 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002282 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002283 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2284 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2285 "stick-table" keyword).
2286
2287 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2288 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2289 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2290 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2291 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2292 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2293 of the stick-table name as follows:
2294
2295 peers mypeers
2296 peer A ...
2297 peer B ...
2298 table t1 ...
2299
2300 frontend fe1
2301 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2302
2303 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2304 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2305
2306 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2307 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2308 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2309 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2310 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2311 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2312 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2313
2314 peers mypeers
2315 peer A ...
2316 peer B ...
2317 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2318
2319 backend t1
2320 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2321
2322 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2323 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2324 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2325
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023263.6. Mailers
2327------------
2328It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2329If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2330in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2331
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002332mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002333 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2334 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2335
2336mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2337 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2338
2339 Example:
2340 mailers mymailers
2341 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2342 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2343
2344 backend mybackend
2345 mode tcp
2346 balance roundrobin
2347
2348 email-alert mailers mymailers
2349 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2350 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2351
2352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2354
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002355timeout mail <time>
2356 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2357 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2358 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2359 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2360
2361 Example:
2362 mailers mymailers
2363 timeout mail 20s
2364 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002365
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023663.7. Programs
2367-------------
2368In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2369master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2370managed the same way as the workers.
2371
2372During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2373sequence as a worker:
2374
2375 - the master is re-executed
2376 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2377 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2378 instance of the program
2379
2380During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2381
2382program <name>
2383 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2384 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2385 the management guide).
2386
2387command <command> [arguments*]
2388 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2389 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2390 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2391 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2392
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002393user <user name>
2394 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2395 See also "group".
2396
2397group <group name>
2398 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2399 See also "user".
2400
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002401option start-on-reload
2402no option start-on-reload
2403 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2404 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2405 program section.
2406
2407
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024083.8. HTTP-errors
2409----------------
2410
2411It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2412imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2413several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2414
2415http-errors <name>
2416 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2417 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2418
2419errorfile <code> <file>
2420 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2421
2422 Arguments :
2423 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2424 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2425 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2426
2427 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2428 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2429 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2430 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2431 before any chroot is performed.
2432
2433 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2434
2435 Example:
2436 http-errors website-1
2437 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2438 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2439 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2440
2441 http-errors website-2
2442 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2443 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2444 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2445
2446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024474. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002448----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002450Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002451 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002452 - frontend <name>
2453 - backend <name>
2454 - listen <name>
2455
2456A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2457its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2458section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002459section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002460
2461A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2462connections.
2463
2464A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2465to forward incoming connections.
2466
2467A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2468parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2471'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2472case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2473
2474Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2475logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2476proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2477However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2478name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2479
2480Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2481and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002482bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2484modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2485arbitrary criteria.
2486
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002487In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2488a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002489the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002490
2491 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2492 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2493 between responses and new requests.
2494
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002495 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2496 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2497 client-facing connection remains open.
2498
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002499 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2500 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002501
2502The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2503frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2504following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002505weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002506
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002507 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002509 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2510 ----+-----+-----+----
2511 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2512 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002513 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2514 ----+-----+-----+----
2515 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025194.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2520--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002522The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2523limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2524they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2525limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002526marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002527option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002528and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2529with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2530specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002531
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002532
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2534------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2535acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536backlog X X X -
2537balance X - X X
2538bind - X X -
2539bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002540capture cookie - X X -
2541capture request header - X X -
2542capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002543compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002544cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002545declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002546default-server X - X X
2547default_backend X X X -
2548description - X X X
2549disabled X X X X
2550dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002551email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002552email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002553email-alert mailers X X X X
2554email-alert myhostname X X X X
2555email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002556enabled X X X X
2557errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002558errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002559errorloc X X X X
2560errorloc302 X X X X
2561-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2562errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002563force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002564filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002565fullconn X - X X
2566grace X X X X
2567hash-type X - X X
2568http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002569http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002570http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002572http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002573http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002574http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002575id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002576ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002577load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002578log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002579log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002580log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002581log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002582max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583maxconn X X X -
2584mode X X X X
2585monitor fail - X X -
2586monitor-net X X X -
2587monitor-uri X X X -
2588option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2589option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2590option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2591option allbackups (*) X - X X
2592option checkcache (*) X - X X
2593option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2594option contstats (*) X X X -
2595option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2596option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002597-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2598option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2600option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002601option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002602option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002603option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002604option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002605option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2607option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2608option httpchk X - X X
2609option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002610option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002611option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002612option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002613option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002614option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002615option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2616option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2617option logasap (*) X X X -
2618option mysql-check X - X X
2619option nolinger (*) X X X X
2620option originalto X X X X
2621option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002622option pgsql-check X - X X
2623option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002624option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002625option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626option smtpchk X - X X
2627option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2628option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2629option splice-request (*) X X X X
2630option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002631option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2633option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2634-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002635option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002636option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2637option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2638option tcpka X X X X
2639option tcplog X X X X
2640option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002641external-check command X - X X
2642external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002643persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2644rate-limit sessions X X X -
2645redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002646-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002647retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002648retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002649server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002650server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002651server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002652source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002653stats admin - X X X
2654stats auth X X X X
2655stats enable X X X X
2656stats hide-version X X X X
2657stats http-request - X X X
2658stats realm X X X X
2659stats refresh X X X X
2660stats scope X X X X
2661stats show-desc X X X X
2662stats show-legends X X X X
2663stats show-node X X X X
2664stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002665-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2666stick match - - X X
2667stick on - - X X
2668stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002669stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002670stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002671tcp-check connect - - X X
2672tcp-check expect - - X X
2673tcp-check send - - X X
2674tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002675tcp-request connection - X X -
2676tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002677tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002678tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002679tcp-response content - - X X
2680tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002681timeout check X - X X
2682timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002683timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002685timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2686timeout http-request X X X X
2687timeout queue X - X X
2688timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002689timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002690timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002691timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002692transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002693unique-id-format X X X -
2694unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002695use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002696use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002697use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2699 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002700
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027024.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2703---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704
2705This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2706
2707
2708acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2709 Declare or complete an access list.
2710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2711 no | yes | yes | yes
2712 Example:
2713 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2714 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2715 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002717 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718
2719
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002720backlog <conns>
2721 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | yes | yes | no
2724 Arguments :
2725 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2726 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002727 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002728
2729 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2730 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2731 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2732 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2733 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2734 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2735 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2736 backlog parameter.
2737
2738 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2739 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2740 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2741
2742 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2743
2744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002747 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2749 yes | no | yes | yes
2750 Arguments :
2751 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2752 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2753 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2754 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2755
2756 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2757 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2758 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2759 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002760 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002761 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002762 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2763 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2764 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2765 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2766 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2767 it, so that you don't worry.
2768
2769 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2770 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2771 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2772 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2773 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2774 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2775 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2776 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002778 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2779 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2780 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2781 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2782 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2783 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2784 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2785 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2786
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002787 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002788 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002789 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2790 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002791 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002792 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2793 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2794 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2795 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2796 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002797 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2798 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2799 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2800 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2801 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2802 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2805 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2806 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2807 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2808 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2809 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2810 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2811 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002812 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002814 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2815 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2816 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002818 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2819 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2820 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2821 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2822 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2823 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2824 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2825 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2826 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2827 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2828 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2829 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002831 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002832 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2833 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2834 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2835 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2836 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2837 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2838 URIs start with a leading "/".
2839
2840 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2841 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2842 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2843 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002846 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2847
2848 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002849 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2850 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002851 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2852 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2853 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2854 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002855 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002856 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2857 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002858
2859 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2860 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2861 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2862 server will receive the request.
2863
2864 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2865 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2866 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2867 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2868 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002869 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2870 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2871 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002872
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002873 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2874 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2875 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2876 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2877 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002879 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002880 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2881 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2882 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2883
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002884 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2885 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2886 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2887
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002888 random
2889 random(<draws>)
2890 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002891 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2892 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2893 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2894 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002895 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2896 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2897 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2898 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2899 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2900 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2901 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2902 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2903 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2904 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2905 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2906 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2907 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2908 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2909 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2910 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2911 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2912 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2913 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2914 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002915
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002916 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002917 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002918 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2919 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2920 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2921 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2922 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2923 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002924 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002925 used instead.
2926
2927 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2928 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2929 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2930 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2931
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002932 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2933 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2934 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2935
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002936 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002937
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002938 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002939 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2940 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002942 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2943 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2944 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002945
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002946 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002947 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002948 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2949 NTLM relies on.
2950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951 Examples :
2952 balance roundrobin
2953 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002954 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002955 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2956 balance hdr(host)
2957 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002958
2959 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2960 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002962 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002963 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2964 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2965 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002966 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002967
2968 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2969 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2970 defaults to 16 kB.
2971
2972 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2973 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2974
2975 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2976 Round Robin.
2977
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002978 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002979 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2980 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2981 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2982
2983 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2984
2985 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002986 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002987 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2988 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2989 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002990
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002991 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992
2993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002994bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2995bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2998 no | yes | yes | no
2999 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003000 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3001 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3002 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3003 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003004 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003005 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3006 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3007 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3008 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3009 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3010 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3011 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003012 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3013 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3014 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3015 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3016 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3017 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3018 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003019 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3020 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3021 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003022 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3023 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3024 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3025 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003026 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3027 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3028 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003029
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003030 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3031 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003032 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3033 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3034 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003035 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3036 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3037 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3038 the range.
3039
3040 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3041 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3042 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3043 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3044 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3045 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3046 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003047 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003048 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003050 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003051 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003052 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3053 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3054 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3055 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3056 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3057 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3058
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003059 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3060 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3061 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3062 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003064 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3065 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3066 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3067 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3068 in a frontend.
3069
3070 Example :
3071 listen http_proxy
3072 bind :80,:443
3073 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003074 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003076 listen http_https_proxy
3077 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003078 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003079
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003080 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3081 bind ipv6@:80
3082 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3083 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3084
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003085 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003086 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003087
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003088 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3089 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3090 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3091 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3092 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3093
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003094 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003095 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003096
3097
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003098bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003099 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3101 yes | yes | yes | yes
3102 Arguments :
3103 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3104 may be used to override a default value.
3105
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003106 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003107 option may be combined with other numbers.
3108
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003109 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003110 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3111 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3112 missing from all processes.
3113
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003114 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003115 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003116 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3117 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3118 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3119 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3120 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003121 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003122
3123 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3124 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3125 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3126 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3127 and 'even' instances.
3128
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003129 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3130 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3131 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3132 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003133
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003134 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3135 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3136
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003137 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3138 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3139 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3140
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003141 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3142 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3143
3144 Example :
3145 listen app_ip1
3146 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003147 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003148
3149 listen app_ip2
3150 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003151 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003152
3153 listen management
3154 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003155 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003156
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003157 listen management
3158 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3159 bind-process 1-4
3160
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003161 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003162
3163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164capture cookie <name> len <length>
3165 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3167 no | yes | yes | no
3168 Arguments :
3169 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3170 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3171 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3172 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003173 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174
3175 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3176 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3177 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3178 right if it exceeds <length>.
3179
3180 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3181 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3182 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3183 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3184
3185 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3186 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3187 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3188
3189 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3190 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3191 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003192 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3193 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3194 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003195
3196 Example:
3197 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3198
3199 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003200 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201
3202
3203capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003204 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3206 no | yes | yes | no
3207 Arguments :
3208 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003209 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3211 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3212 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3213
3214 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3215 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3216 it exceeds <length>.
3217
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003218 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3220 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003221 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3222 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3223 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3224 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003225 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003226 environments to find where the request came from.
3227
3228 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3229 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3230 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3231 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003233 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3234 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3235 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3236 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3237 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
3239 Example:
3240 capture request header Host len 15
3241 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003242 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003244 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245 about logging.
3246
3247
3248capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003249 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3251 no | yes | yes | no
3252 Arguments :
3253 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003254 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003255 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3256 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3257 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3258
3259 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3260 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3261 it exceeds <length>.
3262
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003263 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003264 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3265 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3266 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003267 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3268 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3269 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3270 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003271
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003272 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3273 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3274 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3275 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3276 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003277
3278 Example:
3279 capture response header Content-length len 9
3280 capture response header Location len 15
3281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003282 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003283 about logging.
3284
3285
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003286compression algo <algorithm> ...
3287compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003288compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003289 Enable HTTP compression.
3290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3291 yes | yes | yes | yes
3292 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003293 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3294 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3295 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3296
3297 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003298 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3299 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3300 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003301
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003302 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003303 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003304
3305 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3306 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3307 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3308 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3309 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003310 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003311
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003312 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3313 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3314 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3315 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3316 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3317 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3318 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003319 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003320
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003321 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003322 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003323 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3324 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3325 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3326 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3327 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003328
3329 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3330 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3331 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3332 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3333 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003334 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3335 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3336 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3337 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3338 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003339 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3340 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003341
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003342 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003343 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3344 "Accept-Encoding" header
3345 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003346 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003347 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3348 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3349 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3350 "multipart"
3351 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3352 header
3353 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3354 and later
3355 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3356 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003357 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003358
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003359 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003360
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003361 Examples :
3362 compression algo gzip
3363 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003365
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003366cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003367 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3368 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003369 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3372 yes | no | yes | yes
3373 Arguments :
3374 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3375 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3376 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3377 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3378 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3379 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003380 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3382 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3383
3384 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3385 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3386 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3387 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3388 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3389 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003390 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3391 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003392 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003393 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3394 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003397 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003398
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003399 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003400 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003401 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003402 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003403 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3404 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3405 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3406 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3407 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3408 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3409 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410
3411 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3412 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3413 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3414 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3415 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3416 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3417 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3418 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3419 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003420 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003421 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3422 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3423 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003425 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3426 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3427 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003428 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3429 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3430 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3431 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003432 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3433 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3434 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435
3436 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3437 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3438 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3439 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3440 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3441 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3442 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3443 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3444 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3445
3446 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3447 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3448 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3449 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3450 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3451 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3452 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3453 persistence cookie in the cache.
3454 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3455
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003456 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3457 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3458 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3459 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3460 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003462 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3463 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3464 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3465 they logout.
3466
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003467 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3468 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3469 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3470 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3471
3472 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3473 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3474 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3475 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3476 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3477 this attribute.
3478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003479 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003480 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003481 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3482 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3483 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3484 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3485 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3486 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003487
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003488 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3489 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3490 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3491 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3492 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3493 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3494 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3495 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003496 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003497 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3498 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3499 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3500 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3501 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3502 the site.
3503
3504 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3505 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3506 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3507 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3508 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3509 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3510 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3511 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3512 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3513 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3514 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3515 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3516 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003517 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003518 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3519 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3520
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003521 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3522 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3523 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3524 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3525 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3526 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3527
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003528 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3529 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3530 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3531 repeated.
3532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3534 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3535 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3536 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538 Examples :
3539 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3540 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3541 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003542 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003543
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003544 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003546
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003547declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3548 Declares a capture slot.
3549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3550 no | yes | yes | no
3551 Arguments:
3552 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3553
3554 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3555 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3556 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3557 for use in the response.
3558
3559 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003560 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003561 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3562
3563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003564default-server [param*]
3565 Change default options for a server in a backend
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | no | yes | yes
3568 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003569 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3570 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3571 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3572 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003573
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003574 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003575 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3576
3577 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003580default_backend <backend>
3581 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3583 yes | yes | yes | no
3584 Arguments :
3585 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3586
3587 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3588 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3589 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3590 will catch all undetermined requests.
3591
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003592 Example :
3593
3594 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3595 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3596 default_backend dynamic
3597
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003598 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003601description <string>
3602 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 no | yes | yes | yes
3605 Arguments : string
3606
3607 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3608 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3609 it describes.
3610 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3611
3612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003613disabled
3614 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3616 yes | yes | yes | yes
3617 Arguments : none
3618
3619 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3620 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3621 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3622 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3623 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3624 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3625 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3626
3627 See also : "enabled"
3628
3629
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630dispatch <address>:<port>
3631 Set a default server address
3632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3633 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003634 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003635
3636 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3637 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3638 during start-up.
3639
3640 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3641 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3642 possible with normal servers.
3643
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003644 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003645 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3646 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3647 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3648 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3649
3650 See also : "server"
3651
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003652
3653dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3654 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | no | yes | yes
3657 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3658
3659 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003660 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003661 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3662 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003663 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003664 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003665
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666enabled
3667 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3669 yes | yes | yes | yes
3670 Arguments : none
3671
3672 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3673 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3674
3675 See also : "disabled"
3676
3677
3678errorfile <code> <file>
3679 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3681 yes | yes | yes | yes
3682 Arguments :
3683 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003684 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3685 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003686
3687 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003688 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003690 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3691 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692
3693 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3694 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3695 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3696
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003697 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3698
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003699 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3700 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3701 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3702 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3705 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003706 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3708 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3709 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003711 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3712 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3713 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003714 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003715 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3716
3717 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3718
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003719 Example :
3720 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003721 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003722 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3723 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3724
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003725
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003726errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3727 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3728 section.
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | yes
3731 Arguments :
3732 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3733
3734 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3735 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3736 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3737
3738 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3739 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3740 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3741 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3742 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3743 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3744 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3745
3746 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3747 3.8 about http-errors.
3748
3749 Example :
3750 errorfiles generic
3751 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3752
3753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754errorloc <code> <url>
3755errorloc302 <code> <url>
3756 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3758 yes | yes | yes | yes
3759 Arguments :
3760 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003761 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3762 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003763
3764 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3765 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3766 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3767 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003768 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3771 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3772 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3773
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003774 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003776 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3777 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3778 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3779 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003780 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003781 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3782 request.
3783
3784 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3785
3786
3787errorloc303 <code> <url>
3788 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | yes
3791 Arguments :
3792 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003793 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3794 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003795
3796 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3797 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3798 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3799 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003800 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003801
3802 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3803 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3804 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3805
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003806 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3807
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003808 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3809 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3810 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3811 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003812 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003813
3814 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3815
3816
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003817email-alert from <emailaddr>
3818 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003819 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3821 yes | yes | yes | yes
3822
3823 Arguments :
3824
3825 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3826
3827 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3828 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3829
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003830 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003831 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3832 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003833
3834
3835email-alert level <level>
3836 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3837 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3838 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | yes
3840
3841 Arguments :
3842
3843 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3844 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3845 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3846
3847 By default level is alert
3848
3849 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3850 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3851 for the proxy.
3852
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003853 Alerts are sent when :
3854
3855 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3856 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3857 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3858 is notice or lower
3859 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3860 and a health check status update occurs
3861
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003862 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3863 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003864 section 3.6 about mailers.
3865
3866
3867email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3868 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3870 yes | yes | yes | yes
3871
3872 Arguments :
3873
3874 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3875
3876 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3877 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3878
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003879 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3880 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003881
3882
3883email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3884 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3885 mailers.
3886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3887 yes | yes | yes | yes
3888
3889 Arguments :
3890
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003891 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003892
3893 By default the systems hostname is used.
3894
3895 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3896 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3897 for the proxy.
3898
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003899 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3900 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003901
3902
3903email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003904 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003905 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3907 yes | yes | yes | yes
3908
3909 Arguments :
3910
3911 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3912
3913 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3914 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3915
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003916 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003917 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3918
3919
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003920force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3921 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3922 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003923 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003924
3925 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3926 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3927 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3928 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3929 marked down for maintenance operations.
3930
3931 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3932 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3933 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3934 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3935 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3936 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3937 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3938 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3939 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3940
3941 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3942 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3943 is used.
3944
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003945 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003946 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003947
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003948
3949filter <name> [param*]
3950 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3952 no | yes | yes | yes
3953 Arguments :
3954 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3955 referenced in section 9.
3956
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003957 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003958 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003959 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3960 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003961
3962 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3963 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3964
3965 Example:
3966 listen
3967 bind *:80
3968
3969 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3970 filter compression
3971 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3972
3973 compression algo gzip
3974 compression offload
3975
3976 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3977
3978 See also : section 9.
3979
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003980
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003981fullconn <conns>
3982 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3984 yes | no | yes | yes
3985 Arguments :
3986 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3987 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3988
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003989 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003991 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003992 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3993 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3994 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3995 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3996 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003997 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003998
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003999 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4000 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004001 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4002 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4003 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004005 Example :
4006 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4007 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4008 # connections.
4009 backend dynamic
4010 fullconn 10000
4011 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4012 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4013
4014 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4015
4016
4017grace <time>
4018 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004020 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004021 Arguments :
4022 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4023 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4024 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4025
4026 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4027 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004028 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004029 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4030
4031 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4032 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4033 simplify it.
4034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004036hash-balance-factor <factor>
4037 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | no | no | yes
4040 Arguments :
4041 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4042 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004043 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004044
4045 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4046 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4047 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4048 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4049 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4050 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4051 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4052
4053 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4054 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4055 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4056 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4057 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4058
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004059 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4060 consistent hashing mechanism.
4061
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004062 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4063
4064
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004065hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004066 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4068 yes | no | yes | yes
4069 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004070 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4071 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004072
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004073 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4074 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4075 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4076 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4077 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4078 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4079 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4080 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4081 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4082 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004083
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004084 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4085 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4086 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4087 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4088 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4089 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4090 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4091 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4092 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4093 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4094 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4095 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4096 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004097 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4098 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004099
4100 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4101
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004102 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004103 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4104 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4105 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004106 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4107 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4108 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004109
4110 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4111 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004112 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4113 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4114 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4115 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4116
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004117 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4118 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4119 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4120 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4121 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4122 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4123 parameter.
4124
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004125 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4126 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4127 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4128 used on strings.
4129
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004130 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4131
4132 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4133 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4134 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4135 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4136 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4137 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4138 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4139 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4140 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4141 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4142 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4143 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004144
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004145 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4146 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4147 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004148
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004149 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004150
4151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152http-check disable-on-404
4153 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004155 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004156 Arguments : none
4157
4158 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4159 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4160 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4161 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4162 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4163 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4164 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4165 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004166 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4167 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4168 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4169
4170 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4171
4172
4173http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004174 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004176 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 Arguments :
4178 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4179 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004180 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004181 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4182 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4183 details on the supported keywords.
4184
4185 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4186 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4187 with the usual backslash ('\').
4188
4189 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4190 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4191 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4192 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4193 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4194
4195 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004196 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4198 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4199 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4200
4201 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004202 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4204 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4205 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4206 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4207
4208 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004209 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004210 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4211 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4212 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4213 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4214 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004215 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004216 trace).
4217
4218 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004219 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004220 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4221 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4222 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4223 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4224 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004225 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004226
4227 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4228 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4229 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4230 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4231 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4232 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4233 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4234 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4235
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004236 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4237 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4238 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4239
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004240 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4241 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4242
4243 Examples :
4244 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004245 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004246
4247 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004248 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004249
4250 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004251 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004252
4253 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004254 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004255
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004256 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257
4258
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004259http-check send-state
4260 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4262 yes | no | yes | yes
4263 Arguments : none
4264
4265 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4266 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4267 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4268 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4269 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4270
4271 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4272 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4273 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4274 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4275 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004276 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4277 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4278 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4279
4280 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4281 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4282 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4283
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004284 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4285 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4286 checked in multiple backends.
4287
4288 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4289 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4290
4291 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4292 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4293 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4294 one fails.
4295
4296 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4297 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4298 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4299
4300 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4301 server's queue.
4302
4303 Example of a header received by the application server :
4304 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4305 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4306
4307 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309
4310http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004311 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4312
4313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 no | yes | yes | yes
4315
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004316 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4317 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4318 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4319 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4320 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4323 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327 Example:
4328 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4329 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4330 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004332 http-request allow if nagios
4333 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4334 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4335 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 Example:
4338 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4339 acl add path /addacl
4340 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4345 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 Example:
4348 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4349 acl setmap path /setmap
4350 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4355 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4358 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4363 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4364 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4365 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4366 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4367 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4368 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4369 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4374 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4375 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4376 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4377 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4378 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4379 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4380 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4385 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004386
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4391 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4392 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4393 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4394 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 Example:
4397 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4398 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004399
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004400http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004401
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004402 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4408 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4409 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4410 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4411 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4412 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4413 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4414 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4415 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4418 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4419 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004420 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4421
4422 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4423 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4424 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4425 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4430 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4431 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4432 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4433 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4434 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4443 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4444 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4445 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4446 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4447 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004448
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004449http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4450 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004452 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4453 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4454 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004455 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4456 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4457 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4458 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4459 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004460 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004461
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004462http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4463 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4464 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4465 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4466
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004467http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4468
4469 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4470 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4471 pointed by <resolvers>.
4472 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4473 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4474 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4475 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4476 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4477 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4478 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4479 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4480 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4481 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4482 to 0.0.0.0.
4483
4484 Example:
4485 resolvers mydns
4486 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4487 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4488 timeout retry 1s
4489 hold valid 10s
4490 hold nx 3s
4491 hold other 3s
4492 hold obsolete 0s
4493 accepted_payload_size 8192
4494
4495 frontend fe
4496 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4497 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4498 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4499
4500 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4501 # which mean DNS resolution error
4502 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4503
4504 default_backend be
4505
4506 backend b_503
4507 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4508 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4509 # 503 error page to end users
4510
4511 backend be
4512 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4513 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4514 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4515 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4516 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4517
4518 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4519 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4520
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004521http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4522
4523 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4524 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4525 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4526 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004527 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4528 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004529
4530 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004534 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4535 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4536 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4537 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4538 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4543 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4544 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4545 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004549
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004550 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4551 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4552 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4553 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4554 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4555 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004556
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004557 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4558 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4559 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4560 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4561 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004562
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004563 Example:
4564 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4565
4566 # applied to:
4567 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4568
4569 # outputs:
4570 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4571
4572 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004573
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004574 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4575
4576 # applied to:
4577 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004578
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004579 # outputs:
4580 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004581
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004582http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4583 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4584
4585 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4586 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4587 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4588 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4589
4590 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4591 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4592 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4593
4594 Example:
4595 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4596 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4597
4598 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4599 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4600
4601 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4602 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4603 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4604 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4605
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004606http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4607 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4608
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004609 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4610 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4611 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4612 against.
4613
4614 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4615 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4616 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004617
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004618 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4619 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4620 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4621 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4622 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4623 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4624 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4625 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4626 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004627 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4628 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004629
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004630 Example:
4631 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4632 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004633
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004634 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4635 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4638 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004639
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004640 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4641 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4642 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4643 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004644
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004645 Example:
4646 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004647
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004648 # applied to:
4649 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004650
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004651 # outputs:
4652 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4655http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004657 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4658 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4659 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004660
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004661http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4662 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004663
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004664 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4665 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4666 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4667 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4672 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4673 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4674 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4675 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677 Arguments:
4678 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4679 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004681 Example:
4682 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4683 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4686 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004688http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4691 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4692 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004694 Arguments:
4695 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4696 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 Example:
4699 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4700 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4703 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4704 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004708 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4709 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4710 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4711 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4712 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 Example:
4715 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4716 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4717 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4718 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4719 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4720 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4721 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4722 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4723 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004725http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004727 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4728 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4729 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4730 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4731 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4737 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4738 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4739 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4740 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4741 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4742 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4743 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4744 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4749 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4750 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4751 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4752 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4753 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4754 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4759 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4760 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004764 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4765 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4766 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4767 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4768 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4769 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4770 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4771 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004773http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004775 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4776 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4777 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4778 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4779 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4780 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004782 Example :
4783 # prepend the host name before the path
4784 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004786http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004788 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4789 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4790 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4791 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4792 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004794http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4797 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4798 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4799 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4800 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4801 values have higher priority.
4802 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4803 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4804 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4805 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4806 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004808http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004810 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4811 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4812 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4813 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4814 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4815 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4816 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004818 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004819
4820 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004821 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4822 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004824http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4825 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4826 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4827 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4828 privacy.
4829
4830 Arguments :
4831 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4832 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004833
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004834 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004835 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4836 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4837
4838 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4839 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4840
4841http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4842
4843 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4844 expression.
4845
4846 Arguments:
4847 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4848 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004849
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004850 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004851 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4852 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4853
4854 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4855 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4856 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4857
4858http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4859
4860 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4861 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4862 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4863 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4864 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4865 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4866 information from the request.
4867
4868 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4869
4870http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4871
4872 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4873 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4874 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4875 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4876 path and the query string.
4877 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4878
4879http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4880
4881 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4882 inline.
4883
4884 Arguments:
4885 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4886 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4887 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4888 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4889 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4890 (request and response)
4891 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4892 processing
4893 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4894 processing
4895 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4896 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4897 and '_'.
4898
4899 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4900 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004901
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004902 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004903 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004905http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4906 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004907
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004908 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4909 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4910 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4911 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4912 agent name must be used.
4913
4914 Arguments:
4915 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4916
4917 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4918 configuration.
4919
4920http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4921
4922 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4923 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4924 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4925 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4926 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4927 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4928 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4929 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4930 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4931 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4932 action.
4933 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4934 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4935 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4936 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4937 you fully understand how it works.
4938
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004939http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4940
4941 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4942 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4943 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4944 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4945 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4946 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4947 processing.
4948
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004949 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004950 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4951 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4952 rules evaluation.
4953
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004954http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4955 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004956
4957 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4958 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4959 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4960 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4961 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4962 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4963 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4964 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4965 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4966 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4967 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004968 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
4969 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4970 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4971 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4972 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004973 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4974
4975http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4976http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4977http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4978
4979 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4980 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4981 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4982 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4983 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4984 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4985 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4986 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4987 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4988 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4989 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4990 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4991
4992 Arguments :
4993 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4994 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4995 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4996 select which table entry to update the counters.
4997
4998 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4999 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5000 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5001 that table until the session ends.
5002
5003 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5004 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5005 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5006 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5007 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5008 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5009 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5010 useful information.
5011
5012 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5013 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5014 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5015 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5016 checks that make use of it.
5017
5018http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5019
5020 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005021
5022 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005023 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005024
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005025http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5026
5027 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5028 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5029 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5030 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5031 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5032 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5033
5034 Arguments :
5035 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5036
5037 Example:
5038 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005040http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005042 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5043 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5044 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005045
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005048 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5049
5050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5051 no | yes | yes | yes
5052
5053 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5054 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5055 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5056 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5057 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5058 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005060 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5061 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005063 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065 Example:
5066 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5071 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073 Example:
5074 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5079 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5082 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005084http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005086 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5087 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5088 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5089 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5090 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5091 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5092 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5093 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005097 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5098 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5099 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5100 example, or to pass some internal information.
5101 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5102 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5103 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5108 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005109
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005110http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005111
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005112 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005114http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5117 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5118 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5119 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5120 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5121 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5122 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005123
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005124 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5125 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5126 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5127 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5128 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005129
5130 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5131 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5132 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5133 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005135http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5138 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5139 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5140 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5141 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5142 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005144http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005146 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005148http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005149
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005150 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5151 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5152 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5153 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5154 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5155 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005156
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005157http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5158 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005160 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005161 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5162 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005163 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5164 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5165 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5166 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5167 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005168 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005170http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005172 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5173 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5174 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5175 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5176 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5177 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005179http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5180 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005181
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005182 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5183 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005185 Example:
5186 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005188 # applied to:
5189 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005191 # outputs:
5192 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005194 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005196http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005198
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005199 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005200 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005202 Example:
5203 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 # applied to:
5206 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005208 # outputs:
5209 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005211http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5212http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005214 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5215 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5216 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005217
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005218http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5219 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005220
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005221 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5222 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5223 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5224 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005225
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005226http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005228 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5229 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5230 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5231 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5232 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005234 Arguments:
5235 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005237 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5238 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005240http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005242 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5243 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5244 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005246http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5247
5248 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5249 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5250 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5251 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5252 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5253
5254http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5255
5256 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5257 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5258 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5259 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5260 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5261 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5262 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5263 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5264 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5265
5266http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5267
5268 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5269 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5270 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5271 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5272 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5273 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5274 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5275
5276http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5277
5278 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5279 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5280 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5281 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5282 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5283 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5284 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5285 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5286
5287http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5289
5290 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5291 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5292 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5293 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005294
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005295 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005296 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5297 http-response set-status 431
5298 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5299 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005301http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005303 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5304 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5305 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5306 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5307 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5308 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5309 based on some information from the request.
5310
5311 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5312
5313http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5314
5315 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5316 inline.
5317
5318 Arguments:
5319 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5320 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5321 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5322 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5323 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5324 (request and response)
5325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5326 processing
5327 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5328 processing
5329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5330 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5331 and '_'.
5332
5333 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5334 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005335
5336 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005337 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005338
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005339http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005341 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5342 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5343 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5344 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5345 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5346 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5347 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5348 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5349 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5350 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5351 action.
5352 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5353 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5354 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5355 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5356 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005357
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005358http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5359
5360 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5361 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5362 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5363 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5364 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5365 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5366 processing.
5367
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005368 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005369 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5370 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5371 rules evaluation.
5372
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005373http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5374http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5375http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005376
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005377 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5378 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5379 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5380 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5381 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5382 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5383
5384http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5385
5386 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5387 about <var-name>.
5388
5389 Example:
5390 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5391
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005392
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005393http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5394 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5395
5396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | no | yes | yes
5398
5399 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005400 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5401 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5402 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005403
5404 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5405
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005406 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5407 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5408 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5409 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5410 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5411 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5412 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5413 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5414 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5415 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005416
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005417 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5418 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5419 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5420 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5421 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5422 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5423 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5424 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005425
5426 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5427 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5428 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5429 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5430 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5431 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5432 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5433 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005434 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005435 downsides of rare connection failures.
5436
5437 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5438 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5439 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5440 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5441 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5442 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005443 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005444 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5445 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5446 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5447 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5448 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5449
5450 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005451 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5452 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5453 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005454
5455 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005456 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005457
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005458 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5459 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005460
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005461 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005462
5463 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5464 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5465 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5466
5467 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5468
5469
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005470http-send-name-header [<header>]
5471 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005472 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5473 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005474 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005475 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5476
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005477 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5478 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5479 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5480 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5481 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5482 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5483 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5484 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5485 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5486 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5487 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5488 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5489 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5490 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5491 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5492 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005493
5494 See also : "server"
5495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005496id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005497 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 no | yes | yes | yes
5500 Arguments : none
5501
5502 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5503 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5504 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005505
5506
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005507ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5508 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005510 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005511
5512 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5513 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5514 and running).
5515
5516 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5517 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5518 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005519 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005520 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5521
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005522 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5523 "unless" condition is met.
5524
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005525 Example:
5526 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5527 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5528 ignore-persist if url_static
5529
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005530 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5531
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005532load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5533 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5535 yes | no | yes | yes
5536
5537 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5538 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5539 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005540 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5542 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5543 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5544 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5545
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005546 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005547 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005548 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005549
5550 Arguments:
5551 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5552 named "server-state-file".
5553
5554 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5555 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5556 name is used as a file name.
5557
5558 none don't load any stat for this backend
5559
5560 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005561 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5562 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5563 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005564 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005565 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005566
5567 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5568 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5569
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005570 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005571
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005572 global
5573 stats socket /tmp/socket
5574 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005576 defaults
5577 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005578
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005579 backend bk
5580 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5581 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005582
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005583
5584 Then one can run :
5585
5586 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5587
5588 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5589
5590 1
5591 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5592 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5593 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5594
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005595 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005596
5597 global
5598 stats socket /tmp/socket
5599 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5600
5601 defaults
5602 load-server-state-from-file local
5603
5604 backend bk
5605 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5606 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005609 Then one can run :
5610
5611 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5612
5613 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5614
5615 1
5616 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5617 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5618 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5619
5620 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5621 "show servers state"
5622
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005623
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005624log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005625log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5626 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005627no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005628 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005631
5632 Prefix :
5633 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5634 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5635 prefix does not allow arguments.
5636
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005637 Arguments :
5638 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5639 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5640 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5641 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5642 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5643 parameter.
5644
5645 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5646 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5647
5648 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5649 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5650 standard syslog port).
5651
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005652 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5653 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5654 standard syslog port).
5655
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005656 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5657 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5658 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005659 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005660
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005661 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5662 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5663 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5664 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5665 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5666 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5667 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5668 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5669 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5670 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5671 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5672 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5673 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5674 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5675 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5676 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005677 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5678 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005679
5680 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5681 and "fd@2", see above.
5682
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005683 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5684 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5685 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5686 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5687 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5688 having the logs instantly available.
5689
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005690 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5691 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005692
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005693 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5694 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5695 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5696 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5697 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5698 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5699 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5700 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5701 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5702 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005703 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005704
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005705 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5706 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5707 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5708 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5709 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5710
5711 <sample_size>
5712 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5713 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5714 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5715 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5716 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5717
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005718 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5719 one of the following :
5720
5721 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5722 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5723
5724 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5725 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5726
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005727 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5728 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5729 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5730 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5731 systemd logger consumes.
5732
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005733 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5734 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5735 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5736 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5737
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005738 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5739
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005740 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5741 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5742 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5743
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005744 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5745 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5746 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5747 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005748
5749 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5750 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5751 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005752 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5753 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5754 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5755 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5756 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005757
5758 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5759
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005760 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5761 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5762 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005763
5764 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5765 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5766 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5767 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5768
5769 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5770 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005771
5772 Example :
5773 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005774 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5775 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5776 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005777 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5778 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005779 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005781
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005782log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005783 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5785 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005786
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005787 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5788 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5789 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5790 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5791 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005792
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005793 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5794 "option httplog" directives.
5795
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005796log-format-sd <string>
5797 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | yes | yes | no
5800
5801 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5802 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5803 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5804 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5805 which covers the log format string in depth.
5806
5807 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5808 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5809
5810 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5811 log format to "rfc5424".
5812
5813 Example :
5814 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5815
5816
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005817log-tag <string>
5818 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 yes | yes | yes | yes
5821
5822 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5823 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5824 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5825 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5826 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5827 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5828 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5829 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5830 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005831
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005832max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5833 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5834 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5835 yes | no | yes | yes
5836
5837 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5838 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5839 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5840 servers.
5841
5842 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5843 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5844 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5845 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5846 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005847 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005848 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5849 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5850 picking a different server.
5851
5852 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5853 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5854 even if they have to be queued.
5855
5856 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5857 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5858
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005859max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5860 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5861 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5862 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005863
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005864maxconn <conns>
5865 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 yes | yes | yes | no
5868 Arguments :
5869 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5870 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5871 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5872 closes.
5873
5874 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5875 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5876 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5877 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005878 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5879 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5880 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5881 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005882
5883 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5884 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5885 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5886
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005887 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5888 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005889
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005890 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5891
5892
5893mode { tcp|http|health }
5894 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | yes | yes | yes
5897 Arguments :
5898 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5899 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5900 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5901 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5902
5903 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5904 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5905 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5906 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5907 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5908
5909 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005910 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5911 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5912 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5913 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5914 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5915 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5916 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005917
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005918 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5919 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5920 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005921
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005922 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005923 defaults http_instances
5924 mode http
5925
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005926 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005928
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005929monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005930 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005933 Arguments :
5934 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5935 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005936 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005937 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5938 backend and its backup.
5939
5940 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5941 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5942 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5943 servers in a list of backends.
5944
5945 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5946 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5947 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5948 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5949 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5950 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5951 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005952 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5953 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005954
5955 Example:
5956 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005957 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005958 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5959 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5960 monitor-uri /site_alive
5961 monitor fail if site_dead
5962
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005963 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005964
5965
5966monitor-net <source>
5967 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 yes | yes | yes | no
5970 Arguments :
5971 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5972 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5973 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5974 followed by a mask.
5975
5976 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5977 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005978 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005979 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5980
5981 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5982 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5983 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5984 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005985 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5986 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5987 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005988
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005989 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5990 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5991 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5992 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5993 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5994 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005995
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005996 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5997 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005998
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005999 Example :
6000 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6001 frontend www
6002 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6003
6004 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6005
6006
6007monitor-uri <uri>
6008 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6010 yes | yes | yes | no
6011 Arguments :
6012 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6013 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6014
6015 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6016 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6017 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6018 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6019 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6020 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6021 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6022 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6023
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006024 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006025 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6026 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6027 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6028 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6029 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6030 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006031
6032 Example :
6033 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6034 frontend www
6035 mode http
6036 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6037
6038 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006040
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006041option abortonclose
6042no option abortonclose
6043 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6045 yes | no | yes | yes
6046 Arguments : none
6047
6048 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6049 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6050 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6051 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006052 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006053 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6054 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6055 encountered while delivering the response.
6056
6057 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6058 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6059 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6060 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6061 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6062 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006063 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006064 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006065 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006066 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6067 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6068 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6069
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006070 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6071 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006072 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6073 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6074 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6075 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6076 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6077 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006078 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006079
6080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6082
6083 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6084
6085
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006086option accept-invalid-http-request
6087no option accept-invalid-http-request
6088 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6090 yes | yes | yes | no
6091 Arguments : none
6092
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006093 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006094 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006095 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006096 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6097 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6098 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6099 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6100 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006101 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6102 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6103 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6104 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006105 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006106 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006107 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6108 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6109 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006110
6111 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6112 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6113 been confirmed.
6114
6115 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6116 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006117 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6118 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006119 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6120
6121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6123
6124 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6125 stats socket.
6126
6127
6128option accept-invalid-http-response
6129no option accept-invalid-http-response
6130 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6132 yes | no | yes | yes
6133 Arguments : none
6134
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006135 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006136 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006137 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006138 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6139 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6140 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6141 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6142 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006143 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6144 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6145 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006146
6147 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6148 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6149 been confirmed.
6150
6151 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6152 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6153 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6154 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6155
6156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6158
6159 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6160 stats socket.
6161
6162
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006163option allbackups
6164no option allbackups
6165 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | no | yes | yes
6168 Arguments : none
6169
6170 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6171 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6172 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6173 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6174 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6175 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6176 order between the backup servers anymore.
6177
6178 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6179 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6180
6181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6183
6184
6185option checkcache
6186no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006187 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 yes | no | yes | yes
6190 Arguments : none
6191
6192 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6193 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006194 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006195 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6196 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006197 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006198
6199 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006200 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006201 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006202 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6203 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006204 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006205 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006206 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6207 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006208 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006209 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6210 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006211 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006212 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6213 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6214 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6215 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6216 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6217 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6218 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6219 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6220 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6221
6222 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006223 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6224 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6225 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6226 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006227
6228 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6229 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006230 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006231 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006232
6233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6235
6236
6237option clitcpka
6238no option clitcpka
6239 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6241 yes | yes | yes | no
6242 Arguments : none
6243
6244 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6245 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006246 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006247 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6248
6249 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6250 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6251 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6252 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6253
6254 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6255 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6256 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6257 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6258 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6259
6260 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6261
6262 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6263 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6264 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6265
6266 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6267 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6268
6269 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6270
6271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006272option contstats
6273 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6275 yes | yes | yes | no
6276 Arguments : none
6277
6278 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6279 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6280 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6281 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006282 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6283 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6284 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6285 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6286 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006287
6288
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006289option dontlog-normal
6290no option dontlog-normal
6291 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | yes | yes | no
6294 Arguments : none
6295
6296 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6297 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6298 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6299 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6300 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6301 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6302 logged.
6303
6304 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6305 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6306 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006308 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006309 logging.
6310
6311
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006312option dontlognull
6313no option dontlognull
6314 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6316 yes | yes | yes | no
6317 Arguments : none
6318
6319 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6320 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6321 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6322 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6323 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6324 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006325 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6326 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6327 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006328
6329 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006330 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006331 would not be logged.
6332
6333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6335
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006336 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6337 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006338
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006339
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006340option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006341 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6343 yes | yes | yes | yes
6344 Arguments :
6345 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6346 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006347 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006348 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006349
6350 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6351 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6352 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6353 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6354 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6355 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6356 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006357 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6358 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6359 possible that the client has already brought one.
6360
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006361 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006362 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006363 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006364 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006365 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006366 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006367
6368 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6369 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6370 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6371 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6372 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6373 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6374 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6375
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006376 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6377 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6378 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6379 are under the control of the end-user.
6380
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006381 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006382 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6383 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006384 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6385 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6386 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006387
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006388 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006389 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6390 frontend www
6391 mode http
6392 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6393
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006394 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6395 backend www
6396 mode http
6397 option forwardfor header X-Client
6398
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006399 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006400 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006401
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006402
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006403option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6404no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6405 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6407 yes | yes | yes | no
6408 Arguments : none
6409
6410 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6411 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6412 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6413 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6414 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6415 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6416 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6417
6418 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6419 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6420 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6421 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6422 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6423 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6424 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6425 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6426 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6427 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6428
6429 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6430
6431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6433
6434 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6435 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6436
6437
6438option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6439no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6440 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | no | yes | yes
6443 Arguments : none
6444
6445 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6446 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6447 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6448 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6449 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6450 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6451 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6452
6453 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6454 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6455 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6456 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6457 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6458 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6459 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6460 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6461 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6462 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6463
6464 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6465
6466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6468
6469 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6470 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6471
6472
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006473option http-buffer-request
6474no option http-buffer-request
6475 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6477 yes | yes | yes | yes
6478 Arguments : none
6479
6480 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6481 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6482 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6483 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6484 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6485 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006486 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6487 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6488 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6489 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006490
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006491 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006492
6493
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006494option http-ignore-probes
6495no option http-ignore-probes
6496 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6498 yes | yes | yes | no
6499 Arguments : none
6500
6501 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6502 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6503 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6504 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6505 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6506 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6507 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6508 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6509 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006510 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6511 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006512 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6513
6514 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6515 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6516 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6517 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6518 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6519 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6520 are often the only way to detect them.
6521
6522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6524
6525 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6526
6527
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006528option http-keep-alive
6529no option http-keep-alive
6530 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6532 yes | yes | yes | yes
6533 Arguments : none
6534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006535 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6536 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006537 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6538 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006539 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6540 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6541 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006542
6543 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6544 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006545 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6546 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6547 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6548 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6549 situations where this option may be useful :
6550
6551 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006552 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006553
6554 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6555 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6556
6557 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6558 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6559 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6560 request.
6561
6562 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6563 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006564 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6565 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6566 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006567
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006568 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6569 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6570 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6571 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6572 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6573 not set.
6574
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006575 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6576 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6577 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006578
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006580 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006581 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006582
6583
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006584option http-no-delay
6585no option http-no-delay
6586 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6588 yes | yes | yes | yes
6589 Arguments : none
6590
6591 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6592 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6593 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6594 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6595 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6596 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6597 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6598 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6599 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6600 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6601 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6602 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6603 affected.
6604
6605 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6606 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6607 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6608 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6609 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6610 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6611 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6612 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6613 latency environments.
6614
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006615 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6616
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006617
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006618option http-pretend-keepalive
6619no option http-pretend-keepalive
6620 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006622 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006623 Arguments : none
6624
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006625 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006626 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6627 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6628 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6629 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6630 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6631 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6632 consider the response complete.
6633
6634 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6635 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6636 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6637 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006638 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006639 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6640
6641 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6642 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6643 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6644 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6645 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6646 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6647 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6648
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006649 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6650 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6651 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6652 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6653 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6654 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006655
6656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6658
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006659 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006660 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006661
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006662
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006663option http-server-close
6664no option http-server-close
6665 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 yes | yes | yes | yes
6668 Arguments : none
6669
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006670 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6671 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6672 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6673 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006674 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6675 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6676 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6677 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6678 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6679 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6680 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6681 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6682 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6683 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6684 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006685
6686 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6687 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6688 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6689 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006690 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6691 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006692
6693 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6694 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006695 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6696 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6697 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006698
6699 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6700 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6701
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006702 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6703 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006704
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006705option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006706no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006707 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 yes | yes | yes | no
6710 Arguments : none
6711
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006712 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006713 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6714 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6715 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6716 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6717 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6718 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6719
6720 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6721 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006722 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6723 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6724 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006725
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006726 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6727 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6728 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6729 front of an existing proxy.
6730
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006731 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6732
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006733 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006734
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006735option httpchk
6736option httpchk <uri>
6737option httpchk <method> <uri>
6738option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6739 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6741 yes | no | yes | yes
6742 Arguments :
6743 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6744 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6745 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6746 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6747 ones.
6748
6749 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6750 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6751 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6752
6753 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6754 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6755 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6756 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6757 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6758
6759 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6760 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6761 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6762 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6763 the lack of any response.
6764
6765 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6766
6767 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6768 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6769 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6770
6771 Examples :
6772 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6773 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6774 backend https_relay
6775 mode tcp
6776 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6777 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6778
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006779 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6780 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6781 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006782
6783
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006784option httpclose
6785no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006786 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6788 yes | yes | yes | yes
6789 Arguments : none
6790
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006791 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6792 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6793 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6794 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006795 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006796
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006797 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6798 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006799 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006800 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6801 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006802
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006803 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6804 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6805 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006806
6807 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6808 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006809 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6810 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6811 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006812
6813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6815
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006816 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006817
6818
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006819option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006820 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006822 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006823 Arguments :
6824 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6825 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6826 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006827 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006828 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006829
6830 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6831 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6832 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6833 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6834 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6835 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6836 ports.
6837
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006838 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6839 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006840
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006841 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006843 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006844
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006845
6846option http_proxy
6847no option http_proxy
6848 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 yes | yes | yes | yes
6851 Arguments : none
6852
6853 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6854 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6855 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6856 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6857 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6858
6859 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6860 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006861 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6862 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006863
6864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6866
6867 Example :
6868 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6869 backend direct_forward
6870 option httpclose
6871 option http_proxy
6872
6873 See also : "option httpclose"
6874
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006875
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006876option independent-streams
6877no option independent-streams
6878 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | yes | yes | yes
6881 Arguments : none
6882
6883 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6884 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6885 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6886 receive data or not.
6887
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006888 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006889 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6890 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6891 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6892 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6893 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6894 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6895 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6896 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6897 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6898 socket buffers.
6899
6900 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6901 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6902 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6903 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6904 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6905
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006906 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006907
6908
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006909option ldap-check
6910 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | no | yes | yes
6913 Arguments : none
6914
6915 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6916 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6917 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6918 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6919
6920 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6921 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6922
6923 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6924 configure it.
6925
6926 Example :
6927 option ldap-check
6928
6929 See also : "option httpchk"
6930
6931
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006932option external-check
6933 Use external processes for server health checks
6934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6935 yes | no | yes | yes
6936
6937 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6938 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6939 command".
6940
6941 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6942
6943 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6944
6945
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006946option log-health-checks
6947no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006948 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951 Arguments : none
6952
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006953 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6954 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6955 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006956
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006957 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6958 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6959 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6960 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6961 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6962
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006963 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006964 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006965
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006966 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6967 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6968 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006969
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006970
6971option log-separate-errors
6972no option log-separate-errors
6973 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6975 yes | yes | yes | no
6976 Arguments : none
6977
6978 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6979 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6980 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6981 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6982 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6983 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6984 provides very important information.
6985
6986 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6987 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6988 error logs.
6989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006990 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006991 logging.
6992
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006993
6994option logasap
6995no option logasap
6996 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6998 yes | yes | yes | no
6999 Arguments : none
7000
7001 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7002 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7003 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7004 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7005 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7006 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7007 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007008 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007009 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7010 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7011
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007012 Examples :
7013 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7014 mode http
7015 option httplog
7016 option logasap
7017 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7018
7019 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7020 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7021 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7022 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007024 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007025 logging.
7026
7027
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007028option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007029 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7031 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007032 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007033 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7034 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007035 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007036
7037 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7038 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007039 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007040 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7041 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7042 in the MySQL table, like this :
7043
7044 USE mysql;
7045 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7046 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7047
7048 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007049 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007050 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7051 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7052 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7053 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7054 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7055 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7056 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7057
7058 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7059 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007060
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007061 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007062
7063 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7064 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7065 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7066 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007067 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7068 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007069
7070 See also: "option httpchk"
7071
7072
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007073option nolinger
7074no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007075 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7077 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007078 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007080 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007081 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7082 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7083 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7084 connections.
7085
7086 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7087 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7088 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7089 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7090 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7091 this too.
7092
7093 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7094 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7095 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7096
7097 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7098 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7099 for servers.
7100
7101 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7102 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7103
7104
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007105option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7106 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7108 yes | yes | yes | yes
7109 Arguments :
7110 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7111 matching <network>
7112 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7113 header name.
7114
7115 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7116 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7117 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7118 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7119 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7120 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7121 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7122 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7123 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7124 possible that the client has already brought one.
7125
7126 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7127 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7128 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7129 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7130 header and requires different one.
7131
7132 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7133 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7134 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7135 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7136 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7137 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7138 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7139
7140 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7141 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7142 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7143 both are defined.
7144
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007145 Examples :
7146 # Original Destination address
7147 frontend www
7148 mode http
7149 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7150
7151 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7152 backend www
7153 mode http
7154 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7155
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007156 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007157
7158
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007159option persist
7160no option persist
7161 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007164 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007165
7166 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7167 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7168 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7169 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7170 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7171 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7172 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7173 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7174 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7175 redirected to another valid server.
7176
7177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7179
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007180 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007181
7182
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007183option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7184 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7186 yes | no | yes | yes
7187 Arguments :
7188 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7189 PostgreSQL server.
7190
7191 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7192 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7193 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7194 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7195
7196 See also: "option httpchk"
7197
7198
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007199option prefer-last-server
7200no option prefer-last-server
7201 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7203 yes | no | yes | yes
7204 Arguments : none
7205
7206 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7207 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7208 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7209 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7210 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7211 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7212 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7213 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7214 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007215 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7216 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007217 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7218 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7219 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007220 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7221 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7222 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007223
7224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7226
7227 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7228
7229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007230option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007231option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007232no option redispatch
7233 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7235 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007236 Arguments :
7237 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7238 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7239 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007240 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007241 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007242 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007243 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7244 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7245 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007247
7248 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7249 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7250 be able to access the service anymore.
7251
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007252 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7253 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007254
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007255 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007256 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7257 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7261
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007262 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007263
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007264
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007265option redis-check
7266 Use redis health checks for server testing
7267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7268 yes | no | yes | yes
7269 Arguments : none
7270
7271 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7272 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7273 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7274 find the "+PONG" response message.
7275
7276 Example :
7277 option redis-check
7278
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007279 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007280
7281
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007282option smtpchk
7283option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7284 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7286 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007287 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007288 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007289 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007290 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7291
7292 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7293 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7294 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7295
7296 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7297 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7298 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7299 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7300 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7301 dead server.
7302
7303 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7304 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007305 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007306 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7307
7308 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7309 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7310 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7311 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007312 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007313
7314 Example :
7315 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7316
7317 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007320option socket-stats
7321no option socket-stats
7322
7323 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | yes | yes | no
7326
7327 Arguments : none
7328
7329
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007330option splice-auto
7331no option splice-auto
7332 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 yes | yes | yes | yes
7335 Arguments : none
7336
7337 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7338 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007339 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007340 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007341 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007342 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7343 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7344 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7345 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7346
7347 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7348 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7349 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7350 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7351 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7352 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7353 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7354 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7355 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7356 keyword.
7357
7358 Example :
7359 option splice-auto
7360
7361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7363
7364 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7365 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7366
7367
7368option splice-request
7369no option splice-request
7370 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 yes | yes | yes | yes
7373 Arguments : none
7374
7375 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007376 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007377 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7378 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7379 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7380 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7381
7382 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7383
7384 Example :
7385 option splice-request
7386
7387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7389
7390 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7391 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7392
7393
7394option splice-response
7395no option splice-response
7396 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7398 yes | yes | yes | yes
7399 Arguments : none
7400
7401 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007402 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007403 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7404 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7405 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7406 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7407
7408 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7409
7410 Example :
7411 option splice-response
7412
7413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7415
7416 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7417 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7418
7419
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007420option spop-check
7421 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 no | no | no | yes
7424 Arguments : none
7425
7426 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7427 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7428 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7429 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7430
7431 Example :
7432 option spop-check
7433
7434 See also : "option httpchk"
7435
7436
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007437option srvtcpka
7438no option srvtcpka
7439 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 yes | no | yes | yes
7442 Arguments : none
7443
7444 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7445 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007446 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007447 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7448
7449 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7450 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7451 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7452 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7453
7454 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7455 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7456 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7457 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7458 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7459
7460 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7461
7462 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7463 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7464 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7465
7466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7468
7469 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7470
7471
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007472option ssl-hello-chk
7473 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7475 yes | no | yes | yes
7476 Arguments : none
7477
7478 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7479 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7480 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7481 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7482 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7483 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7484 hello message.
7485
7486 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7487 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7488 messages, which is appreciable.
7489
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007490 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7491 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7492 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007493
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007494 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7495
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007496
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007497option tcp-check
7498 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7500 yes | no | yes | yes
7501
7502 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7503 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7504
7505 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7506 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7507 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7508
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007509 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007510 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7511 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7512 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7513 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7514 only.
7515
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007516 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007517 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7518 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7519 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7520 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7521
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007522 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007523 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7524 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007525 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007526 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7527 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7528 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7529 the respective protocols.
7530 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007531 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007532
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007533 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7534 script.
7535
7536 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7537 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7538 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7539 The "comment" is of course optional.
7540
7541
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007542 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007543 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007544 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007545 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007546
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007547 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007548 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007549 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007550
7551 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7552 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007553 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007554 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007555 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007556 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007557 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007558 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007559 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7560 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007561 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007562 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7563 tcp-check expect string +OK
7564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007565 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007566 (send many headers before analyzing)
7567 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007568 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007569 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7570 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7571 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7572 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007573 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007574
7575
7576 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7577
7578
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007579option tcp-smart-accept
7580no option tcp-smart-accept
7581 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7583 yes | yes | yes | no
7584 Arguments : none
7585
7586 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7587 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7588 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7589 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7590 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7591 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7592
7593 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7594 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7595 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7596 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7597
7598 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7599 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7600 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007601 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007602
7603 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7604 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7605 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7606
7607 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7608 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7609 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7610
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007611 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7612
7613
7614option tcp-smart-connect
7615no option tcp-smart-connect
7616 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7618 yes | no | yes | yes
7619 Arguments : none
7620
7621 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7622 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7623 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7624 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7625 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7626
7627 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7628 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7629 complex.
7630
7631 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7632 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7633 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7634
7635 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7636 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7637
7638 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7639
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007640
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007641option tcpka
7642 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7644 yes | yes | yes | yes
7645 Arguments : none
7646
7647 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7648 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007649 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007650 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7651
7652 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7653 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7654 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7655 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7656
7657 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7658 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7659 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7660 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7661 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7662
7663 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7664
7665 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7666 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7667 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7668 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7669 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7670 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7671 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7672 backends.
7673
7674 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7675
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007676
7677option tcplog
7678 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007680 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007681 Arguments : none
7682
7683 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7684 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7685 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7686 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7687 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7688 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7689 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7690 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7691
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007692 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007694 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007695
7696
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007697option transparent
7698no option transparent
7699 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007701 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007702 Arguments : none
7703
7704 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7705 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7706 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7707 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7708 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7709 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7710 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7711 appropriate server.
7712
7713 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7714 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7715
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007716 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007717 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007718
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007719
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007720external-check command <command>
7721 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7723 yes | no | yes | yes
7724
7725 Arguments :
7726 <command> is the external command to run
7727
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007728 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7729
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007730 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007731
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007732 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7733 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7734 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7735 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7736 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7737 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007738
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007739 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7740
7741 Environment variables :
7742 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7743 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7744
7745 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7746
7747 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7748
7749 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7750 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7751 for a UNIX socket).
7752
7753 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7754
7755 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7756
7757 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7758
7759 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7760
7761 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7762
7763 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7764 socket).
7765
7766 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7767 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7768
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007769 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7770
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007771 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7772 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7773 failed.
7774
7775 Example :
7776 external-check command /bin/true
7777
7778 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7779
7780
7781external-check path <path>
7782 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 yes | no | yes | yes
7785
7786 Arguments :
7787 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7788
7789 The default path is "".
7790
7791 Example :
7792 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7793
7794 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7795 "external-check command"
7796
7797
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007798persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007799persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007800 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7802 yes | no | yes | yes
7803 Arguments :
7804 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007805 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7806 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007807
7808 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7809 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007810 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007811 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7812 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7813 forwarded to this server.
7814
7815 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7816 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7817 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007818 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007819 a single "listen" section.
7820
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007821 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7822 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7823 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7824
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007825 Example :
7826 listen tse-farm
7827 bind :3389
7828 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7829 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7830 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7831 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7832 persist rdp-cookie
7833 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007834 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007835 balance rdp-cookie
7836 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7837 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7838
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007839 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7840 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007841
7842
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007843rate-limit sessions <rate>
7844 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7846 yes | yes | yes | no
7847 Arguments :
7848 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7849 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7850
7851 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7852 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7853 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7854 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7855 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7856 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7857
7858 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7859 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7860 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7861 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7862
7863 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7864 listen smtp
7865 mode tcp
7866 bind :25
7867 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007868 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007869
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007870 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7871 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7872 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007873
7874 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7875
7876
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007877redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7878redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7879redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007880 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 no | yes | yes | yes
7883
7884 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007885 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007886
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007887 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007888 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007889 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7890 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7891 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007892
7893 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7894 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7895 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7896 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7897 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007898 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7899 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7900 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7901 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007902
7903 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7904 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7905 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7906 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7907 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7908 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007909 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007910 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007911 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7912 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7913 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007914
7915 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007916 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7917 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7918 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007919 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007920 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7921 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7922 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7923 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007924
7925 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007926 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007927
7928 - "drop-query"
7929 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7930 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7931 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7932 with a location-type redirect.
7933
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007934 - "append-slash"
7935 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7936 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7937 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7938 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7939
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007940 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7941 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7942 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7943 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7944 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7945 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7946 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7947
7948 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7949 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7950 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7951 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7952 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7953 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7954 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007955
7956 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7957 acl clear dst_port 80
7958 acl secure dst_port 8080
7959 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007960 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007961 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007962 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7963
7964 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007965 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7966 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7967 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007968 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007969
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007970 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7971 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7972 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7973
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007974 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007975 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007976
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007977 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007978 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7979 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7980 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007982 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007983
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007984
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007985retries <value>
7986 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7988 yes | no | yes | yes
7989 Arguments :
7990 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7991 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7992 default value is 3.
7993
7994 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7995 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7996 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7997
7998 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007999 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8000 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008001
8002 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8003 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8004
8005 See also : "option redispatch"
8006
8007
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008008retry-on [list of keywords]
8009 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 yes | no | yes | yes
8012 Arguments :
8013 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8014 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8015 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8016 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8017
8018 none never retry
8019
8020 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8021 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8022
8023 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8024 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8025 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8026 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8027 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8028 processing the request.
8029
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008030 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8031 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8032 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8033 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8034 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8035 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8036 overflow attack for example).
8037
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008038 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8039 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8040 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8041 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8042 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8043 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8044 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8045 amplify denial of service attacks.
8046
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008047 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8048 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8049 considered to be safe to retry.
8050
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008051 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8052 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8053 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8054 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8055
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008056 all-retryable-errors
8057 retry request for any error that are considered
8058 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8059 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8060 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8061
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008062 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8063 not cumulative.
8064
8065 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8066 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8067 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8068 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8069
8070 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8071 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8072 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8073 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8074 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8075 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8076 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8077 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8078 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8079 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8080 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8081 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8082
8083 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8084 should not use this directive.
8085
8086 The default is "conn-failure".
8087
8088 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8089
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008090server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091 Declare a server in a backend
8092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8093 no | no | yes | yes
8094 Arguments :
8095 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008096 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008097 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008098
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008099 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8100 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8101 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8102 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008103 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8104 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8105 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8106 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8107 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008108 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8109 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8110 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8111 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8112 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8113 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8114 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008115 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008116 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8117 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8118 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8119 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8120 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8121 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008122 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8123 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008124 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8125 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008126
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008127 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008128 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8129 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8130 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8131 adding this value to the client's port.
8132
8133 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8134 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008135 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008136
8137 Examples :
8138 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8139 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008140 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008141 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8142 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8143 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008144
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008145 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8146 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8147 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8148 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8149 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8150
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008151 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8152 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008153
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008154server-state-file-name [<file>]
8155 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8156 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8157 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8158 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8159 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8160 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8161
8162 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8163 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8164
8165 global
8166 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8167
8168 backend bk
8169 load-server-state-from-file
8170
8171 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8172 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008173
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008174server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8175 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8176 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 no | no | yes | yes
8179
8180 Arguments:
8181 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8182
8183 <num | range>
8184 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8185 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8186 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8187 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8188
8189 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8190
8191 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8192
8193 <params*>
8194 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8195 keyword.
8196
8197 Examples:
8198 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8199 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8200 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8201
8202 # or
8203 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8204
8205 # would be equivalent to:
8206 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8207 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8208 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8209
8210
8211
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008212source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008213source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008214source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008215 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | no | yes | yes
8218 Arguments :
8219 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8220 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008221
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008222 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008223 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8224 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8225 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8226 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8227 supported prefixes are :
8228 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8229 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8230 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008231 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008232 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8233 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008234
8235 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8236 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008237 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8238 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8239 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008240
8241 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8242 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8243 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8244 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8245 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8246 <addr>.
8247
8248 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8249 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8250 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8251 port.
8252
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008253 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8254 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8255 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8256 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008257 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008258 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8259 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8260 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8261 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8262 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8263 HTTP header.
8264
8265 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8266 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008267 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008268 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8269 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8270 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8271 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8272 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8273 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8274 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8275
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008276 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8277 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8278 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8279 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8280 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8281 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008283 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8284 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8285 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8286 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8287
8288 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8289 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8290 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8291 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8292 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8293 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8294
8295 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8296 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8297 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8298 there are two methods :
8299
8300 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8301 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8302 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8303 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8304 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8305 of the client ranges may be used.
8306
8307 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8308 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8309 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8310 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8311 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8312 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8313 same session.
8314
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008315 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8316 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8317 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008318 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008319
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008320 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8321
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008322 Examples :
8323 backend private
8324 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8325 source 192.168.1.200
8326
8327 backend transparent_ssl1
8328 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8329 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8330
8331 backend transparent_ssl2
8332 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8333 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8334 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8335
8336 backend transparent_ssl3
8337 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8338 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8339 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8340
8341 backend transparent_smtp
8342 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8343 # with Tproxy version 4.
8344 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8345
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008346 backend transparent_http
8347 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8348 # proxy.
8349 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008351 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008352 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8353
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008354
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008355stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8356 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008358 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008359
8360 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8361 matched.
8362
8363 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8364 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8365
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008366 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8367 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008368 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008369
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008370 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8371 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8372 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8373 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008374
8375 Example :
8376 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8377 backend stats_localhost
8378 stats enable
8379 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8380
8381 Example :
8382 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8383 backend stats_auth
8384 stats enable
8385 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8386 stats admin if TRUE
8387
8388 Example :
8389 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8390 userlist stats-auth
8391 group admin users admin
8392 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8393 group readonly users haproxy
8394 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8395
8396 backend stats_auth
8397 stats enable
8398 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8399 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8400 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8401 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8402
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008403 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8404 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8405 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008406
8407
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008408stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8409 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008411 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008412 Arguments :
8413 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8414
8415 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8416
8417 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8418 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8419 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8420 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8421 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8422 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8423
8424 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8425 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8426 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008427 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008428
8429 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8430 report using "stats scope".
8431
8432 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8433 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8434 unobvious parameters.
8435
8436 Example :
8437 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8438 backend public_www
8439 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8440 stats enable
8441 stats hide-version
8442 stats scope .
8443 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008444 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008445 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8446 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8447
8448 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8449 backend private_monitoring
8450 stats enable
8451 stats uri /admin?stats
8452 stats refresh 5s
8453
8454 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8455
8456
8457stats enable
8458 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008460 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008461 Arguments : none
8462
8463 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8464 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8465 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8466 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8467 - stats auth : no authentication
8468 - stats scope : no restriction
8469
8470 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8471 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8472 unobvious parameters.
8473
8474 Example :
8475 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8476 backend public_www
8477 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8478 stats enable
8479 stats hide-version
8480 stats scope .
8481 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008482 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008483 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8484 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8485
8486 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8487 backend private_monitoring
8488 stats enable
8489 stats uri /admin?stats
8490 stats refresh 5s
8491
8492 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8493
8494
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008495stats hide-version
8496 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008498 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008499 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008500
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008501 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8502 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8503 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8504 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8505 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8506 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008508 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8509 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8510 unobvious parameters.
8511
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008512 Example :
8513 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8514 backend public_www
8515 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008516 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008517 stats hide-version
8518 stats scope .
8519 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008520 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008521 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8522 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008523
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008524 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8525 backend private_monitoring
8526 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008527 stats uri /admin?stats
8528 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008529
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008530 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008531
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008532
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008533stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8534 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8535 Access control for statistics
8536
8537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 no | no | yes | yes
8539
8540 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8541 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8542 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8543 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8544 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8545 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8546
8547 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8548 instance.
8549
8550 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8551 about ACL usage.
8552
8553
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554stats realm <realm>
8555 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008557 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008558 Arguments :
8559 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8560 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8561 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8562
8563 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8564 using a backslash ('\').
8565
8566 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8567 only related to authentication.
8568
8569 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8570 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8571 unobvious parameters.
8572
8573 Example :
8574 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8575 backend public_www
8576 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8577 stats enable
8578 stats hide-version
8579 stats scope .
8580 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008581 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008582 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8583 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8584
8585 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8586 backend private_monitoring
8587 stats enable
8588 stats uri /admin?stats
8589 stats refresh 5s
8590
8591 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8592
8593
8594stats refresh <delay>
8595 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008597 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008598 Arguments :
8599 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8600 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8601 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8602 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8603 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8604 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8605
8606 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8607 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8608 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8609 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8610
8611 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8612 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8613 unobvious parameters.
8614
8615 Example :
8616 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8617 backend public_www
8618 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8619 stats enable
8620 stats hide-version
8621 stats scope .
8622 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008623 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008624 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8625 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8626
8627 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8628 backend private_monitoring
8629 stats enable
8630 stats uri /admin?stats
8631 stats refresh 5s
8632
8633 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8634
8635
8636stats scope { <name> | "." }
8637 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008639 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008640 Arguments :
8641 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8642 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8643 section in which the statement appears.
8644
8645 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8646 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8647 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8648 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8649 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8650 exists.
8651
8652 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8653 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8654 unobvious parameters.
8655
8656 Example :
8657 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8658 backend public_www
8659 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8660 stats enable
8661 stats hide-version
8662 stats scope .
8663 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008664 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008665 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8666 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8667
8668 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8669 backend private_monitoring
8670 stats enable
8671 stats uri /admin?stats
8672 stats refresh 5s
8673
8674 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8675
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008676
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008677stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008678 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008680 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008681
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008682 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008683 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8684
8685 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8686 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8687
8688 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8689 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008690 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008691
8692 Example :
8693 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8694 backend private_monitoring
8695 stats enable
8696 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8697 stats uri /admin?stats
8698 stats refresh 5s
8699
8700 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8701 global section.
8702
8703
8704stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008705 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8707 yes | yes | yes | yes
8708 Arguments : none
8709
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008710 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008711 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8712 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8713 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8714 - IP (socket, server)
8715 - cookie (backend, server)
8716
8717 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8718 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008720
8721 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8722
8723
8724stats show-node [ <name> ]
8725 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008727 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008728 Arguments:
8729 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8730 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8731
8732 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8733 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008734 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008735
8736 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8737 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8738 unobvious parameters.
8739
8740 Example:
8741 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8742 backend private_monitoring
8743 stats enable
8744 stats show-node Europe-1
8745 stats uri /admin?stats
8746 stats refresh 5s
8747
8748 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8749 section.
8750
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008751
8752stats uri <prefix>
8753 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008755 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008756 Arguments :
8757 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8758 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8759 query string.
8760
8761 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8762 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8763 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8764 possible to reach it in the application.
8765
8766 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008767 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008768 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8769 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8770 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8771 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8772
8773 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8774 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8775 an address or a port to statistics only.
8776
8777 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8778 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8779 unobvious parameters.
8780
8781 Example :
8782 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8783 backend public_www
8784 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8785 stats enable
8786 stats hide-version
8787 stats scope .
8788 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008789 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008790 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8791 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8792
8793 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8794 backend private_monitoring
8795 stats enable
8796 stats uri /admin?stats
8797 stats refresh 5s
8798
8799 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8800
8801
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008802stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8803 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008805 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008806
8807 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008808 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008809 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008810 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008811 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8812
8813 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8814 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8815 the "stick-table" statement.
8816
8817 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8818 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8819 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8820 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8821 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8822
8823 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8824 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8825 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8826 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8827 transformation rules.
8828
8829 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8830 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8831 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8832 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8833 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8834 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8835 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8836
8837 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8838 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8839 ACL based conditions.
8840
8841 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8842 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8843 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8844 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8845
8846 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8847 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8848 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8849 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8850
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008851 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8852 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008853 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008854
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008855 Example :
8856 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8857 # last 30 minutes
8858 backend pop
8859 mode tcp
8860 balance roundrobin
8861 stick store-request src
8862 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8863 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8864 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8865
8866 backend smtp
8867 mode tcp
8868 balance roundrobin
8869 stick match src table pop
8870 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8871 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8872
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008873 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008874 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008875
8876
8877stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8878 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8880 no | no | yes | yes
8881
8882 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8883 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8884 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8885 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8886
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008887 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8888 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008889 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008890
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008891 Examples :
8892 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008893 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008894
8895 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8896 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8897 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8898
8899
8900 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8901 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8902 backend http
8903 mode http
8904 balance roundrobin
8905 stick on src table https
8906 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8907 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8908 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8909
8910 backend https
8911 mode tcp
8912 balance roundrobin
8913 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8914 stick on src
8915 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8916 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8917
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008918 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008919
8920
8921stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8922 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8924 no | no | yes | yes
8925
8926 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008927 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008928 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008929 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008930 server is selected.
8931
8932 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8933 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8934 the "stick-table" statement.
8935
8936 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8937 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8938 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8939 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8940 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8941 address.
8942
8943 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8944 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8945 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8946 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8947 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8948 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8949 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8950 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8951 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8952 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8953
8954 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8955 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8956 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8957 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8958 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8959 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8960 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8961
8962 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8963 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8964 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8965 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8966
8967 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8968 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8969 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8970 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8971 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8972 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008973 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8974 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8975 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8976 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8977 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8978 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008979
8980 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8981 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8982 the request.
8983
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008984 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8985 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008986 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008987
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008988 Example :
8989 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8990 # last 30 minutes
8991 backend pop
8992 mode tcp
8993 balance roundrobin
8994 stick store-request src
8995 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8996 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8997 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8998
8999 backend smtp
9000 mode tcp
9001 balance roundrobin
9002 stick match src table pop
9003 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9004 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9005
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009006 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009007 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009008
9009
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009010stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009011 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9012 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009013 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009015 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009016
9017 Arguments :
9018 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9019 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9020 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9021 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9022
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009023 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9024 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9025 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9026 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9027
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009028 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9029 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9030 instance.
9031
9032 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9033 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9034 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9035 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9036 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9037 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009038 to 32 characters.
9039
9040 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9041 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9042 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009043 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009044 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9045 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009046
9047 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009048 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9049 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009050 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9051 increase.
9052
9053 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009054 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9055 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9056 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009057
9058 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9059 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9060 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9061 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009062 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009063 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9064 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9065 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9066 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9067 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9068 parameter (see below).
9069
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009070 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9071 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9072 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9073 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9074 soft restart.
9075
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009076 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9077 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009078
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009079 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9080 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9081 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9082 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009083 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009084 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009085 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9086 if not expiration delay is specified.
9087
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009088 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9089 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9090 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9091 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009092 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9093 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9094 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9095 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9096 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9097 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9098 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9099 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9100 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9101 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9102 types and their arguments.
9103
9104 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9105 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9106 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9107 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9108
9109 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9110 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9111 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009112 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009113
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009114 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9115 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9116 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009117 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009118 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009119 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009120
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009121 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9122 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9123 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9124 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9125
9126 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9127 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9128 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9129 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9130 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9131 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9132
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009133 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9134 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9135 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9136 they were received.
9137
9138 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9139 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9140 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9141 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9142 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9143
9144 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9145 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9146 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9147 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9148 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9149
9150 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9151 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9152 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9153
9154 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9155 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9156 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9157 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9158 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9159
9160 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9161 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9162 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9163 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9164 the client side.
9165
9166 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9167 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9168 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9169 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9170 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9171 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9172 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9173
9174 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9175 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9176 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9177 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9178 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9179 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009180 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009181
9182 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9183 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9184 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9185 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9186 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9187 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9188
9189 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009190 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009191 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9192 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9193
9194 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9195 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9196 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9197 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9198 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9199 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9200 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9201 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9202 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9203 recommended for better fairness.
9204
9205 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009206 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009207 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9208 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9209
9210 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9211 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9212 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9213 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9214 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9215 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9216 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9217 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9218 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9219 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009220
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009221 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9222 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009223 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9224 reference it.
9225
9226 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9227 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009228 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9229 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9230 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009231
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009232 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9233 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9234 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9235 something that can be ignored.
9236
9237 Example:
9238 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9239 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9240 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9241 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9242
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009243 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009244 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009245
9246
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009247stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009248 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9250 no | no | yes | yes
9251
9252 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009253 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009254 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009255 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009256 server is selected.
9257
9258 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9259 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9260 the "stick-table" statement.
9261
9262 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9263 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9264 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9265 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9266
9267 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9268 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9269 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9270 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9271 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9272 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009273 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009274 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9275 rules.
9276
9277 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9278 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9279 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9280 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9281 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9282 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9283 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9284
9285 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9286 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9287 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9288 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9289
9290 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9291 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9292 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9293 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9294 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9295 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009296 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9297 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9298 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9299 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9300 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9301 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9302 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9303 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9304 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009305
9306 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9307
9308 Example :
9309 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9310 backend https
9311 mode tcp
9312 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009313 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009314 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009315
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009316 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9317 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9318
9319 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9320 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9321 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9322
9323 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9324 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009325
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009326 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9327 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9328 # at offset 44.
9329
9330 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9331 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9332
9333 # Learn on response if server hello.
9334 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009335
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009336 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9337 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9338
9339 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9340 extraction.
9341
9342
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009343tcp-check connect [params*]
9344 Opens a new connection
9345 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9346 no | no | yes | yes
9347
9348 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9349 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9350 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9351
9352 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9353 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9354 of the sequence.
9355
9356 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9357 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9358 do.
9359
9360 Parameters :
9361 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9362 use the TCP connection.
9363
9364 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9365 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9366 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9367
9368 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9369
9370 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9371
9372 Examples:
9373 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9374 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9375 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9376 option tcp-check
9377 tcp-check connect
9378 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9379 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9380 tcp-check send \r\n
9381 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9382 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9383 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9384 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9385 tcp-check send \r\n
9386 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9387 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9388
9389 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9390 option tcp-check
9391 tcp-check connect port 110
9392 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9393 tcp-check connect port 143
9394 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9395 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9396
9397 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9398
9399
9400tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009401 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009402 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9403 no | no | yes | yes
9404
9405 Arguments :
9406 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9407 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9408 binary.
9409 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9410 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9411 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9412
9413 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9414 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9415 with the usual backslash ('\').
9416 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009417 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009418 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9419 used upper or lower case.
9420
9421
9422 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9423
9424 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9426 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9427 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9428 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9429 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9430 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9431 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9432
9433 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9434 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9435 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9436 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9437 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9438 expression.
9439
9440 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9441 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9442 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9443 this exact hexadecimal string.
9444 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9445
9446 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9447 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9448 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9449 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9450 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9451 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9452 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9453 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9454 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9455 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9456 the null character.
9457
9458 Examples :
9459 # perform a POP check
9460 option tcp-check
9461 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9462
9463 # perform an IMAP check
9464 option tcp-check
9465 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9466
9467 # look for the redis master server
9468 option tcp-check
9469 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009470 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009471 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9472 tcp-check expect string role:master
9473 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9474 tcp-check expect string +OK
9475
9476
9477 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9478 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9479
9480
9481tcp-check send <data>
9482 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9483 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9484 no | no | yes | yes
9485
9486 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9487 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9488
9489 Examples :
9490 # look for the redis master server
9491 option tcp-check
9492 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9493 tcp-check expect string role:master
9494
9495 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9496 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9497
9498
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009499tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9500 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009501 tcp health check
9502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9503 no | no | yes | yes
9504
9505 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9506 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009507 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009508 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9509 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9510 hexadecimal string.
9511 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9512
9513 Examples :
9514 # redis check in binary
9515 option tcp-check
9516 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9517 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9518
9519
9520 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9521 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9522
9523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009524tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9525 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9527 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009528 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009529 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9530 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009532 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009533
9534 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9535 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009536 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9537 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9538 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9539 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9540 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9541 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009543 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9544 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9545 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9546 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009547
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009548 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009549 - accept :
9550 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9551 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9552 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009554 - reject :
9555 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9556 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9557 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9558 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9559 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9560 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9561 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9562 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9563 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9564 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9565 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009566 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009567
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009568 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9569 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9570 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9571 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9572 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9573 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9574 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9575 hosts.
9576
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009577 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9578 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9579 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9580 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9581 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9582 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9583 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9584 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9585
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009586 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9587 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9588 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9589 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9590 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9591 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9592 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9593 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9594 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009595 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9596 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009597
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009598 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009599 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009600 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9601 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9602 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009603 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009604 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9605 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9606 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9607 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9608 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9609 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9610 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9611 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009613 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009614 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009615 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009616 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009617 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9618 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9619 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009620
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009621 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9622 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9623 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9624 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009625
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009626 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9627 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9628 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9629 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9630 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009631 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9632 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9633 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9634 layer7 information is extracted.
9635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009636 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9637 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9638 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9639 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9640 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009641
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009642 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9643 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9644 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9645 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9646
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009647 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9648 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9649 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9650 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9651
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009652 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9653 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9654 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9655 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9656 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009657
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009658 - set-src <expr> :
9659 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9660 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9661 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009662 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009664 Arguments:
9665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9666 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009667
9668 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009669 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9670
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009671 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9672 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009673
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009674 - set-src-port <expr> :
9675 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9676 expression.
9677
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009678 Arguments:
9679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9680 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009681
9682 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009683 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9684
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009685 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9686 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9687 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009688
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009689 - set-dst <expr> :
9690 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9691 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9692 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9693 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9694 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9695
9696 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9697 followed by some converters.
9698
9699 Example:
9700
9701 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9702 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9703
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009704 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9705 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9706
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009707 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9708 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9709 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9710 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9711
9712
9713 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9714 followed by some converters.
9715
9716 Example:
9717
9718 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9719
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009720 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9721 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9722 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9723
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009724 - "silent-drop" :
9725 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009726 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009727 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9728 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9729 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9730 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9731 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009732 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9733 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009734 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9735 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009736 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009737 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9738 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9739 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9740 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9743 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9744 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009745
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009746 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9747 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9748 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009749
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009750 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009751 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009752 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009753
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009754 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9755 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9756 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009757
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009758 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009759 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9760 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009761
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009762 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9763
9764 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9765
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009766 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9767
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009768 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009769
9770
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009771tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9772 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009774 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009775 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009776 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9777 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009778
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009779 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009780
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009781 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009782 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9783 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9784 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9785 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9788 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9789 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9790 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009791 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9792 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9793 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9794 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9795 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9796 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009797 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009798 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9801 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9802 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9803 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009804
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009805 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009806 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009807 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009808 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9809 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009810 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009811 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009812 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009813 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009814 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009815 - set-dst <expr>
9816 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009817 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009818 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009819 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009820 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009821 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009822
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009823 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9824 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009825 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9826 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009827
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009828 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9829 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9830 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9831 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9832 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9833 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009835 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009836 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9837 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009838
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009839 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009840 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9841 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9842 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9843 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009844 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9845 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9846 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009847
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009848 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009849 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9850 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9851 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009852
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009853 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9854 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9855
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009856 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009857 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9858 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009859
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009860 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9861 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9864 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009865 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009866 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009867 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009868 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9869 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009871 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9872 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009873
9874 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9875 followed by some converters.
9876
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009877 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9878 <var-name>.
9879
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009880 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9881 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9882 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9883 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9884 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9885
9886 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9887 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9888 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9889 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9890 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9891 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9892 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9893 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9894 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9895 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9896 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9897
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009898 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9899 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9900 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9901 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9902 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9903
9904 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9905
9906 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9907
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009908 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9909 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9910 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9911 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9912 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9913 evaluated.
9914
9915 Example:
9916 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9917
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009918 Example:
9919
9920 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009921 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009922
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009923 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009924 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9925 # and reject everything else.
9926 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9927 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009928 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009929 tcp-request content reject
9930
9931 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009932 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9933 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9934 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009935 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009936
9937 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9938 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9939 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009940 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009941 tcp-request content reject
9942
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009943 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009944 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009945 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009946 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009947 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9948 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009949
9950 Example:
9951 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9952 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009953 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009955 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009956 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009957
9958 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009959 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009960 # protecting all our sites
9961 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009962 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9963 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009964 ...
9965 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9966
9967 backend http_dynamic
9968 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009969 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009970 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009971 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009972 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009973 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009974 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009976 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009977
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009978 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9979 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009980
9981
9982tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9983 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009985 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009986 Arguments :
9987 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9988 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9989 as explained at the top of this document.
9990
9991 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9992 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9993 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9994 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9995 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9996
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009997 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9998 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9999 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10000 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10001
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010002 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10003 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010004 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010005 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010006 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10007 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10008 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10009 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010010
10011 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10012 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10013 it pass through unaffected.
10014
10015 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10016 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10017 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010018 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010019 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10020 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010021 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10022 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10023 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010024
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010025 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010026 "timeout client".
10027
10028
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010029tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10030 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 no | no | yes | yes
10033 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010034 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10035 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010036
10037 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010040 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10041 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010042 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10043 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010044
10045 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10046
10047 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10048 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10049 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10050 inserted.
10051
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010052 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010053 - accept :
10054 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10055 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10056 the rules evaluation.
10057
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010058 - close :
10059 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10060 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10061 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10062 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10063 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10064 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010065 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010066 protocols.
10067
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010068 - reject :
10069 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10070 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010071 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010072
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010073 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10074 Sets a variable.
10075
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010076 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10077 Unsets a variable.
10078
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010079 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10080 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10081 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10082 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10083
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010084 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10085 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10086 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10087 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10088
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010089 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10090 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10091 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10092 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10093 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010094
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010095 - "silent-drop" :
10096 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010097 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010098 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10099 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10100 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10101 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10102 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010103 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10104 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010105 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10106 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010107 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010108 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10109 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10110 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10111 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10112
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010113 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10114 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10115
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010116 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10117 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10118 for changing the default action to a reject.
10119
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010120 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10121 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10122 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10123 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010124 period.
10125
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010126 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10127 declared inline.
10128
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010129 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10130 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010131 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010132 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10133 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010134 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010135 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010136 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010137 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10138 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010139 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010140 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10141 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010142
10143 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10144 followed by some converters.
10145
10146 Example:
10147
10148 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10149
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010150 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10151 <var-name>.
10152
10153 Example:
10154
10155 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10156
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010157 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10158 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10159 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10160 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10161 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10162
10163 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10164
10165 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10166
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010167 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10168
10169 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10170
10171
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010172tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10173 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10175 no | yes | yes | no
10176 Arguments :
10177 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10178 below.
10179
10180 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10181
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010182 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010183 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10184 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10185 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10186 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10187 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10188 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10189 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010190 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010191 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10192 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10193 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10194 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10195 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10196 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10197 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10198 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10199 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10200 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10201 instead.
10202
10203 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10204 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10205 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10206 rules which may be inserted.
10207
10208 Several types of actions are supported :
10209 - accept : the request is accepted
10210 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10211 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10212 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010213 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010214 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010215 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010216 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010217 - silent-drop
10218
10219 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10220 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10221 sections for a complete description.
10222
10223 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10224 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10225 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10226
10227 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10228 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10229 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10230 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10231 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10232
10233 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10234 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10235
10236 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10237 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10238 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10239
10240 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10241 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10242 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10243
10244 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10245 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10246 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10247
10248 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10249 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10250 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10251
10252 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10253
10254 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10255
10256
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010257tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10258 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10260 no | no | yes | yes
10261 Arguments :
10262 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10263 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10264 as explained at the top of this document.
10265
10266 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10267
10268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010269timeout check <timeout>
10270 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10271 established.
10272
10273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 yes | no | yes | yes
10275 Arguments:
10276 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10277 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10278 as explained at the top of this document.
10279
10280 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10281 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010282 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010283 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010284 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10285 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10286 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010287
10288 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10289 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10290
10291 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10292 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010293 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010294
10295 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10296 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10297 forget about it.
10298
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010299 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10300 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010301
10302
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010303timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010304 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10306 yes | yes | yes | no
10307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010308 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010309 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10310 as explained at the top of this document.
10311
10312 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10313 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10314 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010315 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10316 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10317 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10318 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010319 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10320 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10321 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010322 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010323 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10325 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010326 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10327 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010328
10329 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10331 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10332 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010333 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010334 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10335
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010336 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010337
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010338 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010340
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010341timeout client-fin <timeout>
10342 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10344 yes | yes | yes | no
10345 Arguments :
10346 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10347 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10348 as explained at the top of this document.
10349
10350 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10351 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10352 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10353 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10354 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10355 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10356 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010357 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10358 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10359 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010360
10361 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10362 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10363 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10364
10365 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10366
10367
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010368timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010369 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10371 yes | no | yes | yes
10372 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010373 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010374 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10375 as explained at the top of this document.
10376
10377 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010378 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010379 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010380 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010381 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10382 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010383
10384 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10385 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10386 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10387 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010388 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010389 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10390
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010391 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010393
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010394timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10395 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10397 yes | yes | yes | yes
10398 Arguments :
10399 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10400 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10401 as explained at the top of this document.
10402
10403 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10404 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10405 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10406 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10407 once the request has started to present itself.
10408
10409 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10410 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10411 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10412 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10413 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10414
10415 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10416 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10417 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10418 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10419
10420 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10421 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010422 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010423 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10424 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010425 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010426
10427 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10428 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10429 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10430 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10431
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010432 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10433 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010434 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10435
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010436 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10437
10438
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010439timeout http-request <timeout>
10440 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010442 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010444 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010445 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10446 as explained at the top of this document.
10447
10448 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10449 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10450 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10451 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10452 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10453 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10454 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010455 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10456 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10457 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10458 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010459 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010460 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10461 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010462
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010463 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10464 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10465 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10466 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10467 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010468 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010469
10470 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10471 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010472 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010473 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10474 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10475
10476 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010477 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10478 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10479 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010480
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010481 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010482 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010483
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010484
10485timeout queue <timeout>
10486 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10488 yes | no | yes | yes
10489 Arguments :
10490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10492 as explained at the top of this document.
10493
10494 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10495 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10496 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10497 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10498 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10499
10500 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10501 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10502 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10503 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10504
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010505 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010506
10507
10508timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010509 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10511 yes | no | yes | yes
10512 Arguments :
10513 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10514 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10515 as explained at the top of this document.
10516
10517 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10518 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10519 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10520 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10521 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10522 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10523 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10524
10525 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10526 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10527 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10528 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10529 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010530 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010531 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010532 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10533 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010534 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10535 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010536
10537 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10538 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10539 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10540 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010541 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010542 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10543
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010544 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010545
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010546
10547timeout server-fin <timeout>
10548 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10550 yes | no | yes | yes
10551 Arguments :
10552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10554 as explained at the top of this document.
10555
10556 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10557 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10558 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10559 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10560 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10561 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10562 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10563 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10564 situations, it should not be needed.
10565
10566 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10567 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10568 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10569
10570 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10571
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010572
10573timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010574 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10576 yes | yes | yes | yes
10577 Arguments :
10578 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10579 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10580 as explained at the top of this document.
10581
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010582 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10583 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10584 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010585
10586 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10587 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10588 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10589 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010590 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010591
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010592 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010593
10594
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010595timeout tunnel <timeout>
10596 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10598 yes | no | yes | yes
10599 Arguments :
10600 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10601 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10602 as explained at the top of this document.
10603
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010604 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010605 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10606 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10607 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010608 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10609 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010610 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10611 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10612 specified.
10613
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010614 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10615 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10616 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10617 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10618 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10619 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10620 state.
10621
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010622 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10623 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10624 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10625 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010626 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010627
10628 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10629 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10630 forget about it.
10631
10632 Example :
10633 defaults http
10634 option http-server-close
10635 timeout connect 5s
10636 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010637 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010638 timeout server 30s
10639 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10640
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010641 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010642
10643
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010644transparent (deprecated)
10645 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010647 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010648 Arguments : none
10649
10650 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10651 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10652 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10653 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10654 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10655 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10656 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10657 appropriate server.
10658
10659 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10660
10661 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10662 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10663
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010664 See also: "option transparent"
10665
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010666unique-id-format <string>
10667 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10669 yes | yes | yes | no
10670 Arguments :
10671 <string> is a log-format string.
10672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010673 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10674 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10675 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10676 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010677
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010678 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10679 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10680 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10681 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10682 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10683 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10684 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10685 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010686
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010687 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10688 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010689
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010690 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010691
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010692 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010693
10694 will generate:
10695
10696 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10697
10698 See also: "unique-id-header"
10699
10700unique-id-header <name>
10701 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10703 yes | yes | yes | no
10704 Arguments :
10705 <name> is the name of the header.
10706
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010707 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10708 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010709
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010710 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010711
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010712 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010713 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10714
10715 will generate:
10716
10717 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10718
10719 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010720
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010721use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010722 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10724 no | yes | yes | no
10725 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010726 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10727 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010728
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010729 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10730 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010731
10732 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10733 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10734 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010735 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010736 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010737 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10738 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010739
10740 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10741 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10742 assign the backend.
10743
10744 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10745 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10746 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10747 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10748 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10749 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10750
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010751 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010752 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010753 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10754 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10755 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10756
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010757 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10758 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10759 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10760 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10761 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10762 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10763 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10764 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10765 cannot be forced from the request.
10766
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010767 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010768 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10769 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10770
10771 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10772 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010773
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010774use-fcgi-app <name>
10775 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10777 no | no | yes | yes
10778 Arguments :
10779 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10780
10781 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010782
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010783use-server <server> if <condition>
10784use-server <server> unless <condition>
10785 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10787 no | no | yes | yes
10788 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010789 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010790
10791 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10792
10793 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10794 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10795 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10796
10797 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10798 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10799 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10800 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10801 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10802 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10803 matches will assign the server.
10804
10805 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10806 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10807 with the next rules until one matches.
10808
10809 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10810 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10811 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10812 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10813
10814 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10815 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10816 stripped.
10817
10818 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10819 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10820 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10821 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10822
10823 Example :
10824 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10825 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10826 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10827 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10828 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10829 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010830 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010831 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10832 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10833
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010834 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010835
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010836
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108375. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010838--------------------------
10839
10840The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10841depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10842settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10843written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10844described in this section.
10845
10846
108475.1. Bind options
10848-----------------
10849
10850The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10851as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10852no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10853parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10854while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10855provided immediately after the setting name.
10856
10857The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10858
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010859accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10860 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10861 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10862 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10863 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10864 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10865 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10866 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10867 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10868 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010869 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10870 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10871 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010872
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010873accept-proxy
10874 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010875 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10876 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010877 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10878 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10879 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10880 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010882 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10883 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010884 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10885 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010886
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010887allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010888 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010889 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010890 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010891 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10892 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010893
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010894alpn <protocols>
10895 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10896 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10897 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010898 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010899 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010900 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10901 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10902 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10903 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10904 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10905 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10906 preference, like below :
10907
10908 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010909
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010910backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010911 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010912 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10913
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010914curves <curves>
10915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10916 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10917 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10918 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10919 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10920 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10921
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010922ecdhe <named curve>
10923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010924 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10925 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010926
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010927ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10929 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10930 client's certificate.
10931
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010932ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10934 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10935 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10936 error is ignored.
10937
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010938ca-sign-file <cafile>
10939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10940 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10941 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10942 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10943 'generate-certificates' for details.
10944
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010945ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10947 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10948 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10949 'generate-certificates' for details.
10950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010951ciphers <ciphers>
10952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10953 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010954 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010955 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010956 information and recommendations see e.g.
10957 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10958 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10959 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10960
10961ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10962 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10963 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10964 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10965 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010966 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10967 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010968
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010969crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10971 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10972 to verify client's certificate.
10973
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010974crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10976 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10977 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10978 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10979 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10980 file.
10981
10982 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10983 are loaded.
10984
10985 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010986 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010987 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10988 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10989 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10990 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010991 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10992 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010993 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010994
10995 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10996 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10997 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10998 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010999 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11000 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011001
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011002 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011003
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011004 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011005 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011006 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11007 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011008 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11009 clients).
11010
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011011 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11012 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11013 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11014 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11015 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11016 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11017 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11018 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11019 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11020 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11021 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11022 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11023 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11024
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011025 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11026 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11027 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11028 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11029 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11030
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011031 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11032 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11033 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11034 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011035
11036 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11037 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11038 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11039 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11040 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11041 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11042 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11043 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11044 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11045
11046 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11047
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011048 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011049 a cert bundle.
11050
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011051 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011052 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11053 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11054 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11055 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11056 provide multi-cert support.
11057
11058 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11059
11060 Filename | CN | SAN
11061 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11062 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011063 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011064 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11065 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11066
11067 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11068 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11069 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11070 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011071 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11072 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11073 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011074
11075 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11076 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11077
11078 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11079 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11080 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11081
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011082crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011085 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011086 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011087
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011088crt-list <file>
11089 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011090 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11091 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011092
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011093 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11094
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011095 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11096 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011097 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011098 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011099
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011100 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11101 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11102 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11103 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11104 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11105 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11106 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11107 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011108
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011109 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011110 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011111 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11112 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11113 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011114
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011115 crt-list file example:
11116 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011117 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011118 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011119 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011120
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011121defer-accept
11122 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11123 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11124 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011125 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011126 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11127 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11128 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11129 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11130 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11131 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11132 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11133
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011134expose-fd listeners
11135 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11136 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011137 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11138 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011139 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011140
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011141force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011142 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011143 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011144 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011145 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011146
11147force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011148 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011149 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011150 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011151
11152force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011153 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011154 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011155 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011156
11157force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011158 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011159 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011160 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011161
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011162force-tlsv13
11163 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11164 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011165 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011166
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011167generate-certificates
11168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11169 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11170 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11171 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11172 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11173 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11174 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11175 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11176 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11177 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11178 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11179
11180 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11181 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011182 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011183 certificate is used many times.
11184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011185gid <gid>
11186 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11187 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11188 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11189 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11190 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11191
11192group <group>
11193 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11194 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11195 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11196 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11197 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11198
11199id <id>
11200 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11201 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11202 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11203 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11204
11205interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011206 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11207 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11208 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11209 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11210 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11211 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011212 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11213 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11214 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11215 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11216 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11217 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011218
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011219level <level>
11220 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11221 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11222 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011223 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011224 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11225 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11226 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011227 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011228 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011229 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011230 all counters).
11231
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011232severity-output <format>
11233 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11234 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11235 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11236 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11237 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11238 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11239 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11240 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11241 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11242 rfc5424 convention.
11243
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011244maxconn <maxconn>
11245 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11246 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11247 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11248 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11249 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11250 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11251 eat all memory.
11252
11253mode <mode>
11254 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11255 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11256 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11257 UNIX sockets.
11258
11259mss <maxseg>
11260 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11261 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11262 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11263 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11264 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11265 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11266 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11267 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11268 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11269 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11270 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11271
11272name <name>
11273 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11274 page.
11275
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011276namespace <name>
11277 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11278 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11279 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11280 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11281
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011282nice <nice>
11283 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11284 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11285 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11286 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11287 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11288 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11289 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11290 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11291 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11292 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11293 one for an RDP socket.
11294
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011295no-ca-names
11296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11297 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11298
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011299no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011301 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011302 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011303 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011304 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11305 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011306
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011307no-tls-tickets
11308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11309 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11310 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011311 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11312 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011313
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011314no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011316 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011317 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011318 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011319 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11320 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011321
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011322no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011323 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011324 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011325 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011326 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011327 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11328 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011329
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011330no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011332 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011333 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011334 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011335 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11336 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011337
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011338no-tlsv13
11339 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11340 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11341 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11342 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011343 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11344 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011345
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011346npn <protocols>
11347 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11348 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11349 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011350 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011351 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011352 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11353 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11354 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11355 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11356 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011357
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011358prefer-client-ciphers
11359 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11360 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11361 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011362 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11363 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11364 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011365
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011366process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011367 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011368 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011369 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011370 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11371 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11372 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11373 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011374 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011375 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11376 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11377 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11378 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11379 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011380
11381 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11382
11383 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11384 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11385 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11386 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11387 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11388 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11389 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11390 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011391
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011392proto <name>
11393 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11394 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11395 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11396 in haproxy -vv.
11397 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11398 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011399 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011400 h2" on the bind line.
11401
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011402ssl
11403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011404 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011405 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11406 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011407 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11408 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011409
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011410ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11411 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11412 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11413 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11414
11415ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11416 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11417 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11419
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011420strict-sni
11421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11422 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11423 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11424 See the "crt" option for more information.
11425
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011426tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011427 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011428 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11429 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011430 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011431 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11432 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11433 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11434 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11435 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11436 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11437 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11438
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011439tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011440 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011441 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11442 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11443 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11444 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11445 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11446 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11447 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011448 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11449 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11450 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011451
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011452tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11453 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011454 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11455 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11456 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11457 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11458 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11459 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11460 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11461 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11462 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11463 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011464 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11465 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011467transparent
11468 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11469 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11470 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11471 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11472 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11473 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11474 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11475 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11476 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11477 so check for support with your vendor.
11478
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011479v4v6
11480 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11481 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11482 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11483 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011484 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011485
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011486v6only
11487 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11488 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11489 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011490 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11491 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011492
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011493uid <uid>
11494 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11495 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11496 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11497 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11498 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11499
11500user <user>
11501 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11502 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11503 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11504 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11505 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11506
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011507verify [none|optional|required]
11508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11509 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11510 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11511 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11512 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011513 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11514 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11515 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11516 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011517
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200115185.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011519------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011521The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11522which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11523arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11524settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11525after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11526Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11527address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011529 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011530 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011531
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011532Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11533keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011535The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011536
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011537addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011538 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011539 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11540 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11541 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11542 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11543 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011544
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011545agent-check
11546 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011547 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011548 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11549 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11550 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011551
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011552 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011553 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011554 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11555 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11556 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11559 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11560 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11561 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11562 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011563
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011564 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011566
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011567 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11568 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11569 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011570
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011571 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11572 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11573 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011574
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011575 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11576 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11577 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11578 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11579 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011580 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011581 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011582
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011583 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11584 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011585
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011586 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11587 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11588 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11589 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11590 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11591 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11592 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11593 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11594 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011595
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011596 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11597 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011598 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11599 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11600 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011601 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011602
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011603 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011604 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011605
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011606agent-send <string>
11607 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11608 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11609 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11610 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11611 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11612
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011613agent-inter <delay>
11614 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11615 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11616
11617 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11618 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11619 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11620 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11621 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11622 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11623 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11624 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11625 of backends use the same servers.
11626
11627 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11628
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011629agent-addr <addr>
11630 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11631
11632 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11633 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11634 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11635 hostname, it will be resolved.
11636
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011637agent-port <port>
11638 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11639
11640 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11641
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011642allow-0rtt
11643 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011644 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11645 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011646
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011647alpn <protocols>
11648 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11649 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11650 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011651 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011652 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11653 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11654 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11655 now obsolete NPN extension.
11656 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11657 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11658
11659 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011661backup
11662 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11663 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11664 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11665 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011666 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11667 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011668
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011669ca-file <cafile>
11670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11671 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11672 server's certificate.
11673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674check
11675 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011676 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11677 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11678 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11679 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11680 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11681 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11682 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011683 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11684 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011685 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11686 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011687
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011688check-send-proxy
11689 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11690 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11691 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11692 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11693 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11694 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11695 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11696
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011697check-alpn <protocols>
11698 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11699 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11700 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11701
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011702check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011703 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011704 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11705 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011706
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011707check-ssl
11708 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11709 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11710 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11711 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011712 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011713 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11714 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011715 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011716 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11717 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011718
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011719check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011720 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011721 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11722 for normal traffic.
11723
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011724ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11726 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11727 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011728 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11729 information and recommendations see e.g.
11730 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11731 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11732 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011733
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011734ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11735 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11736 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11737 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11738 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011739 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11740 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11741 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011743cookie <value>
11744 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11745 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11746 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11747 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11748 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11749 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11750 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11751
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011752crl-file <crlfile>
11753 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11754 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11755 to verify server's certificate.
11756
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011757crt <cert>
11758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11759 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11760 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11761 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11762 certificate request.
11763
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011764disabled
11765 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11766 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11767 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11768 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11769 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011770 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011771
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011772enabled
11773 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11774 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11775 default value.
11776 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11777 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011779error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011780 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11781 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11782 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011784 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011786fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011787 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11788 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11789 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11790
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011791force-sslv3
11792 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11793 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011794 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011795 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011796
11797force-tlsv10
11798 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011799 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011800 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011801
11802force-tlsv11
11803 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011804 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011805 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011806
11807force-tlsv12
11808 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011809 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011810 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011811
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011812force-tlsv13
11813 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11814 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011815 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011817id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011818 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11819 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11820 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011821
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011822init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11823 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11824 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011825 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011826 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11827 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11828 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11829 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11830 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11831 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11832 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11833 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11834 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011835 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011836 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11837 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11838 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11839 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11840 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11841 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011842 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011843
11844 Example:
11845 defaults
11846 # never fail on address resolution
11847 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011849inter <delay>
11850fastinter <delay>
11851downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011852 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11853 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11854 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11855 between checks depending on the server state :
11856
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011857 Server state | Interval used
11858 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11859 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11860 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11861 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11862 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11863 or yet unchecked. |
11864 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11865 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11866 | "inter" otherwise.
11867 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011869 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11870 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11871 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11872 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011873 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11874 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11875 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11876 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11877 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011878
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011879maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011880 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11881 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011882 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11883 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011884 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11885 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11886 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11887 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11888
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011889 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11890 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11891 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11892 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11893 than 50 concurrent requests.
11894
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011895maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011896 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11897 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11898 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11899 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11900 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11901 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11902 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11903
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011904max-reuse <count>
11905 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11906 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11907 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11908 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11909 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11910 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11911 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11912 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011914minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011915 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11916 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11917 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11918 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11919 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11920 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011921 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011922 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011923
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011924namespace <name>
11925 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11926 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11927 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11928 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11929
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011930no-agent-check
11931 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11932 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11933 default value.
11934 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11935 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11936
11937no-backup
11938 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11939 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11940 default value.
11941 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11942 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11943
11944no-check
11945 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11946 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11947 default value.
11948 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11949 "default-server" "check" setting.
11950
11951no-check-ssl
11952 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11953 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11954 default value.
11955 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11956 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11957
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011958no-send-proxy
11959 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11960 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11961 default value.
11962 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11963 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11964
11965no-send-proxy-v2
11966 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11967 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11968 default value.
11969 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11970 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11971
11972no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11973 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11974 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11975 default value.
11976 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11977 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11978
11979no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11980 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11981 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11982 default value.
11983 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11984 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11985
11986no-ssl
11987 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11988 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11989 default value.
11990 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11991 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11992
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011993no-ssl-reuse
11994 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11995 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11996 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11997 and for paranoid users.
11998
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011999no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012000 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12001 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012002 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012003
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012004 Supported in default-server: No
12005
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012006no-tls-tickets
12007 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12008 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12009 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012010 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12011 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012012 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012013
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012014no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012015 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012016 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12017 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012018 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12019 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012020 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012021
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012022 Supported in default-server: No
12023
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012024no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012025 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012026 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12027 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012028 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12029 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012030 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012031
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012032 Supported in default-server: No
12033
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012034no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012035 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012036 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12037 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012038 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12039 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012040 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012041
12042 Supported in default-server: No
12043
12044no-tlsv13
12045 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12046 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12047 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12048 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12049 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012050 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012051
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012052 Supported in default-server: No
12053
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012054no-verifyhost
12055 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12056 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12057 default value.
12058 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12059 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012060
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012061no-tfo
12062 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12063 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12064 default value.
12065 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12066 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12067
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012068non-stick
12069 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12070 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12071 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12072
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012073npn <protocols>
12074 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12075 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12076 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012077 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012078 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12079 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12080 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012082observe <mode>
12083 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12084 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12085 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12086 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12087 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12088 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012089 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012090
12091 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012093on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012094 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12095 Currently, four modes are available:
12096 - fastinter: force fastinter
12097 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12098 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12099 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12100 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12101
12102 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12103
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012104on-marked-down <action>
12105 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12106 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012107 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12108 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12109 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12110 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12111 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12112 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12113 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12114 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012115
12116 Actions are disabled by default
12117
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012118on-marked-up <action>
12119 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12120 Currently one action is available:
12121 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12122 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12123 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12124 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012125 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12126 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012127 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12128 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12129
12130 Actions are disabled by default
12131
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012132pool-max-conn <max>
12133 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12134 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12135 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12136 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12137 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12138 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12139
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012140pool-purge-delay <delay>
12141 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012142 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012143 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012145port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012146 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12147 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12148 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12149 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12150 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12151 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12152
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012153proto <name>
12154
12155 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12156 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12157 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12158 reported in haproxy -vv.
12159 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12160 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012162redir <prefix>
12163 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12164 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12165 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12166 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12167 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12168 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12169 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12170 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012171 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012172 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012173 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12174 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12175 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12176 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12177
12178 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012180rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012181 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12182 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12183 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12184
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012185resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12186 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12187 server.
12188
12189 Available options:
12190
12191 * allow-dup-ip
12192 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12193 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12194 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12195 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12196 For such case, simply enable this option.
12197 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12198
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012199 * ignore-weight
12200 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12201 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12202 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12203
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012204 * prevent-dup-ip
12205 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12206 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12207 same fqdn.
12208 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12209
12210 Example:
12211 backend b_myapp
12212 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12213 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12214 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12215
12216 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12217 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12218 it
12219 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12220 different address
12221
12222 Default value: not set
12223
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012224resolve-prefer <family>
12225 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12226 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12227 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12228 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12229
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012230 Default value: ipv6
12231
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012232 Example:
12233
12234 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012235
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012236resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012237 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012238 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012239 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012240 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12241 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012242 configured network, another address is selected.
12243
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012244 Example:
12245
12246 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012247
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012248resolvers <id>
12249 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12250 hostname.
12251
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012252 Example:
12253
12254 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012255
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012256 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012257
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012258send-proxy
12259 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12260 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12261 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12262 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012263 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12264 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12265 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12266 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12267 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12268 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12269 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12270 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12271 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12272 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012273 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12274 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012275
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012276send-proxy-v2
12277 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12278 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12279 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12280 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012281 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12282 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12283 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12284 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012285
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012286proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12287 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12288 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012289 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12290 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012291 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12292 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012293 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012294
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012295send-proxy-v2-ssl
12296 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12297 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12298 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12299 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12300 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12301 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12302 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012303 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12304 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012305
12306send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12307 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12308 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12309 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12310 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12311 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12312 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12313 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12314 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012315 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12316 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012318slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012319 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12320 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12321 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12322 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12323 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12324 parameters :
12325
12326 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12327 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12328
12329 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12330 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12331 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12332 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12333
12334 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12335 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12336 seen as failed.
12337
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012338sni <expression>
12339 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12340 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12341 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12342 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012343 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12344 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012345 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012346 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12347 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012348
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012349source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012350source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012351source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012352 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12353 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12354 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12355 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12356
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012357 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12358 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12359 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12360 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12361 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12362 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12363 server.
12364
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012365 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12366 specifying the source address without port(s).
12367
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012368ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012369 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12370 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12371 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12372 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12373 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12374 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012375 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12376 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012377
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012378ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12379 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12380 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12381 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12382
12383ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12384 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12385 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12386 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12387
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012388ssl-reuse
12389 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12390 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12391 default value.
12392 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12393 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12394
12395stick
12396 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12397 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12398 default value.
12399 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12400 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012401
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012402socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012403 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012404 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12405 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12406
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012407tcp-ut <delay>
12408 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12409 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12410 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012411 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012412 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12413 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12414 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12415 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12416 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12417 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12418 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12419 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12420 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12421
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012422tfo
12423 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12424 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12425 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12426 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12427 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012428 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012430track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012431 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12432 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12433 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12434 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012435 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12436
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012437tls-tickets
12438 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12439 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12440 default value.
12441 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12442 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012443
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012444verify [none|required]
12445 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012446 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012447 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12448 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012449 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012450 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12451 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12452 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12453 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12454 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12455 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12456 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12457 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012458
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012459verifyhost <hostname>
12460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012461 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12462 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12463 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12464 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12465 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12466 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12467 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12468 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012470weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012471 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12472 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12473 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012474 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12475 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12476 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12477 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12478 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12479 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012480
12481
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124825.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12483-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012484
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012485HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12486using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12487configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012488This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12489can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12490workload.
12491This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12492resolution at run time.
12493Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12494carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12495
12496
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124975.3.1. Global overview
12498----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012499
12500As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12501different steps of the process life:
12502
12503 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12504 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12505 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12506
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012507 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12508 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012509
12510A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12511 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12512 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12513 resolution to know this new IP.
12514
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012515When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012516HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012517SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12518from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12519will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12520will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012521
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012522A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012523 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012524 first valid response.
12525
12526 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12527 servers return an error.
12528
12529
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200125305.3.2. The resolvers section
12531----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012532
12533This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012534HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12535contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012536
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012537When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12538uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12539is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12540answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12541
12542When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012543used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012544
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012545 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12546 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12547 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012548
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012549 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12550 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012551
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012552 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12553 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12554 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012555
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012556For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12557following scenarios are possible:
12558
12559 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12560 ignored
12561
12562 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12563 applied
12564
12565 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12566 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12567
12568 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12569 retries the query with a new type
12570
12571 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12572 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012573
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012574As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12575a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012576<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012577
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012578
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012579resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012580 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012581
12582A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12583
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012584accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012585 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012586 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012587 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12588 by RFC 6891)
12589
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012590 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12591
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012592nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12593 DNS server description:
12594 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12595 <ip> : IP address of the server
12596 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12597
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012598parse-resolv-conf
12599 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12600 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12601 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12602
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012603hold <status> <period>
12604 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12605 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012606 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012607 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012608 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12609 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12610 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12611
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012612 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012613
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012614resolve_retries <nb>
12615 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12616 giving up.
12617 Default value: 3
12618
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012619 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12620 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12621 type.
12622
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012623timeout <event> <time>
12624 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12625 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12626 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012627 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12628 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012629 Default value: 1s
12630 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012631 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012632 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012633 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12634 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12635
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012636 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012637
12638 resolvers mydns
12639 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12640 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012641 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012642 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012643 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012644 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012645 hold other 30s
12646 hold refused 30s
12647 hold nx 30s
12648 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012649 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012650 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012651
12652
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200126536. Cache
12654---------
12655
12656HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12657(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12658RAM.
12659
12660The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12661this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12662
12663If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12664independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12665when we try to allocate a new one.
12666
12667The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12668
12669It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12670"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12671for more details.
12672
12673When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12674replaced by "<CACHE>".
12675
12676
126776.1. Limitation
12678----------------
12679
12680The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12681
12682- If the response is not a 200
12683- If the response contains a Vary header
12684- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12685- If the response is not cacheable
12686
12687- If the request is not a GET
12688- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12689- If the request contains an Authorization header
12690
12691
126926.2. Setup
12693-----------
12694
12695To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12696the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12697
12698
126996.2.1. Cache section
12700---------------------
12701
12702cache <name>
12703 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12704 size of cache is mandatory.
12705
12706total-max-size <megabytes>
12707 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12708 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12709
12710max-object-size <bytes>
12711 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12712 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12713 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12714
12715max-age <seconds>
12716 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12717 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12718 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12719 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12720 default.
12721
12722
127236.2.2. Proxy section
12724---------------------
12725
12726http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12727 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12728 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12729 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12730 after this one.
12731
12732http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12733 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12734 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12735 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12736 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12737
12738
12739Example:
12740
12741 backend bck1
12742 mode http
12743
12744 http-request cache-use foobar
12745 http-response cache-store foobar
12746 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12747
12748 cache foobar
12749 total-max-size 4
12750 max-age 240
12751
12752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127537. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12754----------------------------------
12755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012756HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012757client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12758The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12759these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12760but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12761data called patterns.
12762
12763
127647.1. ACL basics
12765---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012766
12767The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12768content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12769from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12770simple :
12771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012772 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012773 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012774 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12775 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012777The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12778adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012779
12780In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012782 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012783
12784This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12785Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12786and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012787an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12788conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12789as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12790are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012791
12792ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12793'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12794which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12795
12796There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12797performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12800specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12801this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012802methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12803ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804
12805Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12806 - boolean
12807 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12808 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12809 - string
12810 - data block
12811
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012812Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12813converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12814would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12815The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12816which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12817
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012818Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12819keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12820fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12821which are summarized in the table below :
12822
12823 +---------------------+-----------------+
12824 | Sample or converter | Default |
12825 | output type | matching method |
12826 +---------------------+-----------------+
12827 | boolean | bool |
12828 +---------------------+-----------------+
12829 | integer | int |
12830 +---------------------+-----------------+
12831 | ip | ip |
12832 +---------------------+-----------------+
12833 | string | str |
12834 +---------------------+-----------------+
12835 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12836 +---------------------+-----------------+
12837
12838Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12839matching method, see below.
12840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12842 - boolean
12843 - integer or integer range
12844 - IP address / network
12845 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12846 - regular expression
12847 - hex block
12848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012849The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12850
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012851 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12852 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012854 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012855 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012856 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012857 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012859The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12860read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12861if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12862lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12863will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12864beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12865a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12866lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12867exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12868
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012869The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12870parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12871ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12872a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12873check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12874
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012875The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12876socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12877file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012879Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12880loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12881
12882 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12883
12884In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12885the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12886case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12887as well.
12888
12889The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12890sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12891do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12892methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12893is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012894obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012895followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12896default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12897that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12898string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12899
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012900The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12901By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12902string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12903resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12904server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012905waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012906flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12907function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012909There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12910sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12911be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012912
12913 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12914 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12916 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12917 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12918 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012919
12920 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12921 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012923
12924 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012926
12927 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012929
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012930 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012931 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12932
12933 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12934 binary or string samples.
12935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12937 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012939 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12940 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12941 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12944 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12947 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12950 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12953 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012954 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12957 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12958 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012959
12960For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12961request, it is possible to do :
12962
12963 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12964
12965In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12966buffer, one would use the following acl :
12967
12968 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12969
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012970On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12971possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12972
12973 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12976criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12977method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12978to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12979criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12980the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012982If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012983the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12984For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12987 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12988 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12989 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012990
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012991
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012992The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12993types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12994combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12995brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12996default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012998 +-------------------------------------------------+
12999 | Input sample type |
13000 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013001 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013002 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13003 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13004 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013005 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013007 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013009 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013011 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013012 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013013 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013015 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013017 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013019 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013021 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013023 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013025 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013026 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13027 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13028 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013029
13030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130317.1.1. Matching booleans
13032------------------------
13033
13034In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13035Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13036When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13037that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13038
13039Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13040return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13041"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130447.1.2. Matching integers
13045------------------------
13046
13047Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13048enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13049to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13050
13051Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13052matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13053lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013054
13055For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13056unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13057representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13058
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013059As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13060two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13061instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13062ranges and operators.
13063
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013064For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013065operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13066Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13067of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013069Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013070
13071 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13072 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13073 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13074 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13075 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013077For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013078
13079 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13080
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013081This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13082
13083 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13084
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130867.1.3. Matching strings
13087-----------------------
13088
13089String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13090different forms :
13091
13092 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013093 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013094
13095 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013096 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097
13098 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13099 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13100
13101 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13102 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13103
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013104 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13106 matches.
13107
13108 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13109 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13110 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013111
13112String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13113exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13114characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13115string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13116to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013117before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013118
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013119Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13120(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13121Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13122
13123Example:
13124 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13125 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13126
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131287.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13129---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013130
13131Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13132they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13133possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13134passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13135the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013136the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13137match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013138
13139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131407.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13141-------------------------------------
13142
13143It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13144not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13145a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13146to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13147digits may be used upper or lower case.
13148
13149Example :
13150 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13151 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13152
13153
131547.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13155---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013156
13157IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13158netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13159within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013160host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013161difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13162at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13163does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13164parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013165
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013166The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13167abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13168
13169 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13170 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13171 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13172 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13173 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13174 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13175 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13176 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13177
13178Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13179192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13180
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013181IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13182Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13183trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13184IPv6 patterns.
13185
13186HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13187following situations :
13188 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13189 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13190 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13191 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13192 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13193 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13194 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13195 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13196 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13197 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013199
132007.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13201----------------------------------
13202
13203Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13204combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13205
13206 - AND (implicit)
13207 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13208 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13215indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13218"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13219requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13220is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13221
13222 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013223 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13224 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13225 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013226
13227To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13228and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13229
13230 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13231 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13232 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13233 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13234
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013235 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13237 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13238 use_backend www if host_www
13239
13240It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13241expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13242be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13243the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13244
13245 The following rule :
13246
13247 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013248 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249
13250 Can also be written that way :
13251
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013252 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253
13254It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13255to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13256simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13257sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13258good use is the following :
13259
13260 With named ACLs :
13261
13262 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13263 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13264 monitor fail if site_dead
13265
13266 With anonymous ACLs :
13267
13268 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13269
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013270See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13271keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013272
13273
132747.3. Fetching samples
13275---------------------
13276
13277Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13278against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13279sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13280ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13281of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13282available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13283
13284This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13285Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13286compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13287deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13288
13289The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13290matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13291method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13292indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13293
13294As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13295when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13296mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13297the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13298ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13299
13300Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13301multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13302when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13304are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013305is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13306all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13307
13308Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13309 - name
13310 - name(arg1)
13311 - name(arg1,arg2)
13312
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013313
133147.3.1. Converters
13315-----------------
13316
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013317Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13318of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13319is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13320was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013322unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13323
13324These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13325sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13326the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013327support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013328
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013329A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13330support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13331supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13332(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13333bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013335The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013336
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001333751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13338 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13339 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13340 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13341 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13342 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13343
13344 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013345 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13346 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013347 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13348 frontend http-in
13349 bind *:8081
13350 default_backend servers
13351 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13352 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13353
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013354add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013355 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013356 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013357 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13358 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13361 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13362 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13363 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013364 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013365 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013366
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013367aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13368 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13369 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13370 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13371 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13372 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13373 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13374
13375 Example:
13376 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13377 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13378
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013379and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013380 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013381 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013382 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13383 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013384 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013385 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13386 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13387 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13388 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013390 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013391
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013392b64dec
13393 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13394 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13395
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013396base64
13397 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013398 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013399 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13400
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013401bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013402 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013403 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013404 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013405 presence of a flag).
13406
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013407bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13408 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13409 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013410 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013411
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013412concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13413 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13414 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13415 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13416 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13417 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13418 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13419 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13420 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13421 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13422 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013423 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013424 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013425 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013426
13427 Example:
13428 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13429 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13430 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13431 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13432
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013433cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013434 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13435 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013436
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013437crc32([<avalanche>])
13438 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13439 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13440 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13441 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13442 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13443 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13444 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13445 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13446 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13447 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013448 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13449
13450crc32c([<avalanche>])
13451 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13452 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13453 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13454 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13455 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13456 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13457 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13458 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013459
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013460da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013461 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13462 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13463 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13464 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013465 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013466 configuration language.
13467
13468 Example:
13469 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013470 bind *:8881
13471 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013472 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013473
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013474debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13475 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13476 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13477 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13478 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13479 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13480 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13481 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13482 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13483 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13484 printable sample types.
13485
13486 Example:
13487 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013488
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013489div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013490 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13491 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013492 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013493 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13494 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013495 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013496 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13497 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13498 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13499 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013500 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013501 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013502
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013503djb2([<avalanche>])
13504 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13505 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13506 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13507 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13508 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13509 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13510 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013511 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13512 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013513
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013514even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013515 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013516 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13517
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013518field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13519 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13520 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13521 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13522 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13523 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13524 fields.
13525
13526 Example :
13527 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13528 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13529 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13530 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13531 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013533hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013534 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013535 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013536 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013537 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013538
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013539hex2i
13540 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013541 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013542
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013543http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013544 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13545 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013546 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13547 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13548 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13549 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13550 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13551 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13552 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13553 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013555in_table(<table>)
13556 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13557 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13558 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013559 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013560 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13561
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013562ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13563 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013564 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013565 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13566 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13567 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13568 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13569 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013570
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013571json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013572 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013573 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013574 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013575 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13576 of errors:
13577 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13578 bytes, ...)
13579 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13580 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13581
13582 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13583 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13584 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13585 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13586 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13587 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013588 - "ascii" : never fails;
13589 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13590 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013591 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013592 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013593 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13594 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13595
13596 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013597 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013598
13599 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013600 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013601 capture request header user-agent len 150
13602 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013603
13604 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13605 GET / HTTP/1.0
13606 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13607
13608 Output log:
13609 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13610
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013611language(<value>[,<default>])
13612 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13613 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13614 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13615 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13616 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13617 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13618 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13619 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13620 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013621 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013622 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13623 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013625 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013626
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013627 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13628 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013630 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13631 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13632 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13633 use_backend spanish if es
13634 use_backend french if fr
13635 use_backend english if en
13636 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013637
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013638length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013639 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13640 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13641 type. The result is of type integer.
13642
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013643lower
13644 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13645 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13646 type. The result is of type string.
13647
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013648ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13649 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13650 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13651 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13652 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13653 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13654 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13655
13656 Example :
13657
13658 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013660 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013662map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13663map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13664map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13665 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13666 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13667 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13668 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13669 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13670 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13671 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13672 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013674 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13675 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13676 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013677
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013678 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013679 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013680
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013681 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13682 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13683 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13684 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013685 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13686 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013687 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13688 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13689 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13690 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13691 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13692 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13693 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13694 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013695 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13696 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13697 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013698 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13699 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13700 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13701 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13702 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013703
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013704 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13705 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13706 the corresponding match text.
13707
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013708 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13709 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13710 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13711 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13712 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013713
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013714 Example :
13715
13716 # this is a comment and is ignored
13717 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13718 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13719 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13720 | | | `---------- value
13721 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13722 | `---------------------------- key
13723 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13724
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013725mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013726 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13727 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013728 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013729 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013730 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013731 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13732 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13733 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13734 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013736 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013737
13738mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013739 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013740 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13741 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013742 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013743 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013744 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013745 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13746 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13747 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13748 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013749 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013750 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013751
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013752nbsrv
13753 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13754 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13755 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13756 map lookup.
13757
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013758neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013759 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13760 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13761 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13762 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013763
13764not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013765 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013766 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013767 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013768 absence of a flag).
13769
13770odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013771 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013772 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13773
13774or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013775 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013776 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013777 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13778 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13782 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13783 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013784 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013785 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013786
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013787protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13788 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13789 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13790 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13791 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13792 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13793 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13794 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13795 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13796 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13797 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13798 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13799
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013800regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013801 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13802 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13803 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13804 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13805 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13806 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13807 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13808 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13809 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13810 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013811 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13812 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13813 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13814 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013815
13816 Example :
13817
13818 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13819 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13820 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13821 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13822
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013823capture-req(<id>)
13824 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13825 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13826
13827 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013828 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13829 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013830
13831capture-res(<id>)
13832 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13833 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13834
13835 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013836 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13837 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013838
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013839sdbm([<avalanche>])
13840 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13841 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13842 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13843 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13844 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13845 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13846 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013847 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13848 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013849
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013850set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013851 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13852 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13853 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013857 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013861 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013862
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013863sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013864 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013865 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13866
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013867sha2([<bits>])
13868 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13869 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13870
13871 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13872 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13873
13874 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13875 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13876
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013877srv_queue
13878 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13879 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13880 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13881 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13882 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13883
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013884strcmp(<var>)
13885 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13886 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13887 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13888 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13889 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13890 shorter).
13891
13892 Example :
13893
13894 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13895 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13896 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13897
13898
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013899sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013900 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13901 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013902 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013903 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13904 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013905 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013906 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13907 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013908 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013909 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13910 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013911 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013912 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013913
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013914table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13915 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13916 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13917 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13918 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13919 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13920 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13921
13922
13923table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13927 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13928 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13929 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13930
13931table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13932 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13933 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013934 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013935 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13936 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13937
13938table_conn_cur(<table>)
13939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13941 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13942 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13943 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13944
13945table_conn_rate(<table>)
13946 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13947 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13948 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13949 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13950 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13951
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013952table_gpt0(<table>)
13953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13956 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13957 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13958
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013959table_gpc0(<table>)
13960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13963 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13964 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13965
13966table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13967 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13968 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13969 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13970 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13971 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13972 sample fetch keyword.
13973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013974table_gpc1(<table>)
13975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13978 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13979 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13980
13981table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13985 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13986 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13987 sample fetch keyword.
13988
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013989table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013993 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13994 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13995
13996table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13999 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14000 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14001 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14002 keyword.
14003
14004table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014007 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014008 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14009 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14010
14011table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14014 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14015 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14016 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14017 keyword.
14018
14019table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014023 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14024 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14025 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14026 keyword.
14027
14028table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14029 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14030 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014031 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014032 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14033 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14034 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14035 keyword.
14036
14037table_server_id(<table>)
14038 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14039 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14040 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14041 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14042 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14043 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14044
14045table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014049 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14050 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14051 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14052 keyword.
14053
14054table_sess_rate(<table>)
14055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14058 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14059 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14060 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14061 keyword.
14062
14063table_trackers(<table>)
14064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14067 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14068 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14069 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14070 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14071 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14072 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14073 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14074
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014075upper
14076 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14077 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14078 type. The result is of type string.
14079
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014080url_dec
14081 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14082 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14083
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014084ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014085 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014086 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14087 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14088 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014089 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14090 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14091 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14092 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014093 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014094 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14095 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014096
14097 Example:
14098 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14099 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14100
14101 message Point {
14102 int32 latitude = 1;
14103 int32 longitude = 2;
14104 }
14105
14106 message PPoint {
14107 Point point = 59;
14108 }
14109
14110 message Rectangle {
14111 // One corner of the rectangle.
14112 PPoint lo = 48;
14113 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14114 PPoint hi = 49;
14115 }
14116
14117 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14118 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14119 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14120
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014121 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14122 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014123 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014124 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14125
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014126 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014127
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014128 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014129
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014130 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014131 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14132 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14133
14134 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14135 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14136 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14137
14138 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14139 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14140 interpret the previous binary sample.
14141
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014142
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014143unset-var(<var name>)
14144 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14145 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14146 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14147 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14148 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14149 response),
14150 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14151 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14152 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14153 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14154
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014155utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14156 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14157 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14158 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14159 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14160 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14161 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14162
14163 Example :
14164
14165 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014166 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014167 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14168
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014169word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14170 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14171 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14172 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14173 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14174 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14175
14176 Example :
14177 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14178 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14179 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14180 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14181 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014182
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014183wt6([<avalanche>])
14184 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14185 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14186 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14187 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14188 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14189 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14190 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014191 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14192 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014193
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014194xor(<value>)
14195 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014196 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014197 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014198 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014199 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014200 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14201 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014202 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014203 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14204 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014205 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014206 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014207
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014208xxh32([<seed>])
14209 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14210 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14211 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14212 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14213 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14214 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14215 as cryptographically secure.
14216
14217xxh64([<seed>])
14218 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14219 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14220 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14221 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14222 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14223 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14224 as cryptographically secure.
14225
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014226
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142277.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228--------------------------------------------
14229
14230A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14231not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14232"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14233The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14234
14235always_false : boolean
14236 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14237 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14238
14239always_true : boolean
14240 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14241 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14242
14243avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014244 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014245 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14246 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14247 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14248 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14249 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14250 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14251 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14252 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14253 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14254 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14255 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14256 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14257 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014259be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014260 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14261 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14262 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14263 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014264 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14265
14266be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14268 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14269 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14270 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14271 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014272 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14273 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014274
14275 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14276 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14277 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014279be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14280 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14281 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14282 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014283 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014284 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14285 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014286
14287 Example :
14288 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14289 backend dynamic
14290 mode http
14291 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14292 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014294bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014295 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14296 of the string.
14297
14298bool(<bool>) : bool
14299 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14300 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014304 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014305 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14306 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014307
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014308 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014309 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014310 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14311
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014312 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14313 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014314
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014315 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014316 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014317 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014318 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014319 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014321 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014322
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014323 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14324 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014326 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014327
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014328cpu_calls : integer
14329 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14330 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14331 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14332 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14333 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14334 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14335
14336cpu_ns_avg : integer
14337 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14338 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14339 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14340 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14341 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14342 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14343 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14344 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14345 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14346 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14347 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14348
14349cpu_ns_tot : integer
14350 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14351 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14352 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14353 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14354 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14355 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14356 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14357 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14358 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14359 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14360 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14361 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14362 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14363
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014364date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014365 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014366
14367 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14368 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14369 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014370 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14371
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014372 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14373 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14374 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14375 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14376 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14377
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014378 Example :
14379
14380 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14381 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014382
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014383 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14384 # millisecond granularity
14385 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14386
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014387date_us : integer
14388 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14389 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14390 from the same timeval structure.
14391
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014392distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14393 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14394 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14395 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14396 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14397 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14398 list of supported tokens.
14399
14400distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14401 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14402 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14403 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14404 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14405 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14406 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14407 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14408 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14409 supported tokens.
14410
14411 Example :
14412 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14413 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14414 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14415 # send large files to the big farm
14416 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14417
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014418env(<name>) : string
14419 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14420 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14421 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14422 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14423 certain way.
14424
14425 Examples :
14426 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14427 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14428
14429 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14430 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14433 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014434 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14435 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14437 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14440 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014441
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014442fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14443 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14444 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14445 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14448 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14449 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14450 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14451 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14452 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14453 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14454 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14455 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014456
14457 Example :
14458 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14459 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14460 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14461 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14462 frontend mail
14463 bind :25
14464 mode tcp
14465 maxconn 100
14466 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14467 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14468 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14469 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014470
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014471hostname : string
14472 Returns the system hostname.
14473
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014474int(<integer>) : signed integer
14475 Returns a signed integer.
14476
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014477ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14478 Returns an ipv4.
14479
14480ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14481 Returns an ipv6.
14482
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014483lat_ns_avg : integer
14484 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14485 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14486 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14487 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14488 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14489 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14490 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14491 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14492 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14493 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14494 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14495 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14496 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14497 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14498
14499lat_ns_tot : integer
14500 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14501 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14502 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14503 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14504 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14505 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14506 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14507 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14508 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14509 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14510 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14511 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14512 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14513 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14514 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14515 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14516 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14517 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14518 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14519
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014520meth(<method>) : method
14521 Returns a method.
14522
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014523nbproc : integer
14524 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14525 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14526 and debugging purposes.
14527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14530 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14531 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014532 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14533 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14534 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014535
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014536prio_class : integer
14537 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14538 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14539 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14540
14541prio_offset : integer
14542 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14543 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14544 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14545 set-priority-offset".
14546
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014547proc : integer
14548 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14549 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14550 debugging purposes.
14551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014553 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14554 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14555 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14557 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14558 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14559 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14560 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14561
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014562rand([<range>]) : integer
14563 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14564 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14565 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14566 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14567 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14568
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014569uuid([<version>]) : string
14570 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14571 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14572 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14575 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14576 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14577 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14578 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14579 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014580 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14581 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14582
14583srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14585 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14586 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14587 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14588 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14589 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14590 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14591
14592 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14593 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014594
14595srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14596 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14597 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14598 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014599 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014600 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14601 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14602 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14603
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014604srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14605 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14606 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14607 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14608 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14609 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14610 fetch methods.
14611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14613 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14614 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014615 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14617 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014618 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619 overloading servers).
14620
14621 Example :
14622 # Redirect to a separate back
14623 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14624 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14625 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14626
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014627stopping : boolean
14628 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14629 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14630 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14631
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014632str(<string>) : string
14633 Returns a string.
14634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14636 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14637 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14638
14639table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14640 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14641 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14642 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14643
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014644thread : integer
14645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14646 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14647 and debugging purposes.
14648
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014649var(<var-name>) : undefined
14650 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014651 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14652 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014656 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014657 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14658 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014659 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014660 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146627.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014663----------------------------------
14664
14665The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14666closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14667methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14668sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14669TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014670the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14671counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014672"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14673used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14674can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14675Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14676table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14677tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14678currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014680bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014681 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14682 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14683 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685be_id : integer
14686 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14687 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14688
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014689be_name : string
14690 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14691 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693dst : ip
14694 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14695 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14696 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14697 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014698 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14699 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14700 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14701 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14702 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14703 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014704
14705dst_conn : integer
14706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14707 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14708 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14709 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14710 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14711 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14712 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14713 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014714
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014715dst_is_local : boolean
14716 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14717 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14718 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14719 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014720 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014721 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14722 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14723 it only once per connection.
14724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725dst_port : integer
14726 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14727 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14728 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14729 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14730 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14731 an HTTP header.
14732
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014733fc_http_major : integer
14734 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14735 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14736 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14737
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014738fc_pp_authority : string
14739 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14740 if any.
14741
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014742fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14743 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14744 header.
14745
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014746fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14747 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14748 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14749 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14750 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14751 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14752 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14753
14754fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14755 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14756 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14757 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14758 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14759 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14760 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14761
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014762fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014763 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14764 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14765 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14766 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14767
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014768fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014769 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14770 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14771 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14772 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14773
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014774fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014775 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14776 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14777 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14778 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14779
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014780fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014781 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14782 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14783 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14784 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14785
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014786fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014787 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14788 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14789 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14790 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14791
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014792fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014793 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14794 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14795 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14796 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14797
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014798fe_defbe : string
14799 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14800 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802fe_id : integer
14803 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014804 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14806
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014807fe_name : string
14808 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14809 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14810 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014812sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014813sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14814sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14815sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014816 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14817 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14818 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014820sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014821sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14822sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14823sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014824 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14825 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14826 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014828sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014829sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14830sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14831sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014832 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14833 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014834 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14835 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14836 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014837
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014838 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014839 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14840 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014841 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14842 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14843 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014844 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14845 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14846
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014847sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14848sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14849sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14850sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14851 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14852 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14853 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14854 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14855 when a first ACL was verified.
14856
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014857sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014858sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14859sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14860sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014861 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014862 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14863
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014864sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014865sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14866sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14867sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014868 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14869 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14870 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014872sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014873sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14874sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14875sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014876 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14877 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14878 See also src_conn_rate.
14879
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014880sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014881sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14882sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14883sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014884 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014885 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014886
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014887sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14888sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14889sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14890sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14891 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14892 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14893
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014894sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14895sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14896sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14897sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14898 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14899 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014901sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014902sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14903sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14904sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014905 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14906 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14907 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014908 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14909 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14910 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014911
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014912sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14913sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14914sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14915sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14916 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14917 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14918 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14919 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14920 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14921 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014923sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014924sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14925sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14926sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014927 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014928 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14929 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14930
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014931sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014932sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14933sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14934sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014935 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14936 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14937 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14938 src_http_err_rate.
14939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014940sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014941sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14942sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14943sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014944 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014945 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14946 src_http_req_cnt.
14947
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014948sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014949sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14950sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14951sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014952 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14953 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14954 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14955 src_http_req_rate.
14956
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014957sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014958sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14959sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14960sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014961 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014962 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14963 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14964 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14965 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014966
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014967 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014968 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14969 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014970 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14971
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014972sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14973sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14974sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14975sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14976 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14977 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14978 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14979 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14980 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14981
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014982sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014983sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14984sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14985sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014986 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14987 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14988 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014990sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014991sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14992sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14993sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014994 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14995 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14996 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014998sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014999sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15000sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15001sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015002 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015003 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15004 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15005 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015006 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015007 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15008
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015009sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015010sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15011sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15012sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015013 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15014 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15015 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15016 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15017 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015018 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015019
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015020sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015021sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15022sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15023sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015024 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15025 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15026 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15027
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015028sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015029sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15030sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15031sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015032 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15033 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015034 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015035 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15036 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15038 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15039 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041so_id : integer
15042 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15043 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15044 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015047 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015048 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15049 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15050 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015051 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15052 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15053 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015054 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15055 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15056 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15057 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15058 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15059 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15060 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015061
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015062 Example:
15063 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15064 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15067 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15068 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15069 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015070 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15073 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15074 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015075 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015076 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15079 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15080 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15081 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15082 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15083 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15084 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015085
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015086 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015087 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15088 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15089 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15090 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015091 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015092 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15093 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15094
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015095src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15096 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15097 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15098 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15099 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15100 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15101 was verified.
15102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015104 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015106 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015107 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015110 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015111 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15112 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015113 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015115src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15116 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15117 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15118 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015119 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015122 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015124 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015125 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015126
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015127src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15128 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15129 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15130 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15131 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15132
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015133src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15134 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15135 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15136 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15137 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015139src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015140 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015142 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15143 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015144 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15145 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15146 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015147
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015148src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15149 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15150 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15151 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15152 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15153 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15154 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15155 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015158 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015159 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015160 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015161 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15165 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15166 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15167 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15168 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015169 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015171src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015172 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15174 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015175 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15178 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15179 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15180 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015181 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015182 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15185 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15186 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15187 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015188 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15190 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015191
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015192 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015193 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015194 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015195 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015196
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015197src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15198 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15199 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15200 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15201 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15202 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15203 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15204
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015205src_is_local : boolean
15206 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15207 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15208 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15209 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015210 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015211 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15212 once per connection.
15213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015215 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15216 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15217 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15218 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15219 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015222 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15223 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15224 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15225 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15226 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228src_port : integer
15229 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15230 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15231 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15232 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015235 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015236 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15237 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15238 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015239 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15242 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15243 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15244 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15245 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015246 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15249 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15250 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15251 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15252 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15253 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15254 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15255 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15256 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015257
15258 Example :
15259 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15260 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15261 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15262 listen ssh
15263 bind :22
15264 mode tcp
15265 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015266 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015267 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015268 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270srv_id : integer
15271 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15272 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15273 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015274
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015275srv_name : string
15276 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15277 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15278 debugging.
15279
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15284closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15285when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15286usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015287future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015288
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001528951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15290 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15291 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15292 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15293 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15294 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15295
15296 Example :
15297 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15298 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15299 # the request.
15300 frontend http-in
15301 bind *:8081
15302 default_backend servers
15303 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15304 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15305
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015306ssl_bc : boolean
15307 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15308 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15309 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15310
15311ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15312 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15313 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15314
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015315ssl_bc_alpn : string
15316 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15317 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015318 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015319 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15320 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15321 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15322 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15323 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15324 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15325
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015326ssl_bc_cipher : string
15327 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15328 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15329
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015330ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15331 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15332 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15333 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15334
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015335ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15336 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15337 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15338 session or a TLS ticket.
15339
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015340ssl_bc_npn : string
15341 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15342 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015343 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015344 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15345 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15346 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15347 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15348 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15349
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015350ssl_bc_protocol : string
15351 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15352 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15353
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015354ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015355 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015356 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15357 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015358
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015359ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15360 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15361 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15362 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15363
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015364ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15365 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15366 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15367 if session was reused or not.
15368
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015369ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15370 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15371 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15372 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15373 BoringSSL.
15374
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015375ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15376 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15377 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015379ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15380 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15381 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15382 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15383 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15384 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15387 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15388 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15389 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15390 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015391
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015392ssl_c_der : binary
15393 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15394 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15395 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015397ssl_c_err : integer
15398 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15399 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15400 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15401 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15402 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015403
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015404ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15406 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15407 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15408 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15409 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15410 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15411 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15412 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015413 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15414 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15415 LDAP v3.
15416 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15417 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419ssl_c_key_alg : string
15420 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15421 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15422 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424ssl_c_notafter : string
15425 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15426 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15427 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429ssl_c_notbefore : string
15430 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15431 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15432 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015433
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015434ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015435 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15436 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15437 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15438 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15439 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15440 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15441 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15442 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015443 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15444 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15445 LDAP v3.
15446 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15447 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015449ssl_c_serial : binary
15450 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15451 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15452 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15455 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15456 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15457 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015458 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15459 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15460
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015461 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015462 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15465 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15466 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15467 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469ssl_c_used : boolean
15470 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15471 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473ssl_c_verify : integer
15474 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15475 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15476 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15477 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479ssl_c_version : integer
15480 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15481 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015482
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015483ssl_f_der : binary
15484 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15485 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15486 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15487
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015488ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15490 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15491 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15492 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015493 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15495 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15496 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015497 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15498 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15499 LDAP v3.
15500 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15501 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015503ssl_f_key_alg : string
15504 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15505 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15506 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508ssl_f_notafter : string
15509 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15510 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15511 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513ssl_f_notbefore : string
15514 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15515 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15516 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015517
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015518ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15520 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15521 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15522 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15523 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15524 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15525 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15526 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015527 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15528 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15529 LDAP v3.
15530 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15531 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533ssl_f_serial : binary
15534 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15535 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15536 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015537
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015538ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15539 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15540 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15541 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15544 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15545 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15546 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548ssl_f_version : integer
15549 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15550 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15551
15552ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015553 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15554 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15555 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 Example :
15558 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15559 listen http-https
15560 bind :80
15561 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15562 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15563
15564ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15565 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15566 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15567
15568ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015569 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15571 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15572 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15573 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15574 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15575 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15576 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15577 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579ssl_fc_cipher : string
15580 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15581 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015582
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015583ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15584 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15585 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015586 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015587
15588ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15589 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15590 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015591 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015592
15593ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15594 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15595 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15596 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015597 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015598 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015599
15600ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15601 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15602 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015603 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015604
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015605ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15606 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15607 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15608 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015611 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15612 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015613 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15614 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15615 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15616 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015617
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015618ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15619 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15620 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15621 wait until the handshake happened.
15622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15624 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015625 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15626 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015627 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015628 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015629
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015630ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015631 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015632 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15633 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015636 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15638 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15639 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15640 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15641 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15642 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15643 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645ssl_fc_protocol : string
15646 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15647 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015648
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015649ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015650 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015651 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15652 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015653
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015654ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15655 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15656 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15657 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15660 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15661 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15662 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15663 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015664
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015665ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15666 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15667 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15668 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15669 BoringSSL.
15670
15671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672ssl_fc_sni : string
15673 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15674 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15675 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15676 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15677 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15678
15679 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15680 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15681 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015682 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015683 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15687 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15690 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15691 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015692
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015693
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156947.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015695------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15698sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15699only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15700For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15701be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15702can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15703sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15704for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15705content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015708 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15710 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15713 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015714 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015716
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015717req.hdrs : string
15718 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15719 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15720 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15721 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15722
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015723req.hdrs_bin : binary
15724 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15725 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15726 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15727 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15728 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15729 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15730
15731 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15732
15733 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15734 str: <int:length><bytes>
15735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736req.len : integer
15737req_len : integer (deprecated)
15738 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15739 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15740 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15741 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15742 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15743 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15744 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15745 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15748 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015749 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15750 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15751 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15752 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754 ACL alternatives :
15755 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15758 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15759 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15760 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15761 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763 ACL alternatives :
15764 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768req.proto_http : boolean
15769req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15770 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15771 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15772 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15773 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15774 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15775 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15776 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778 Example:
15779 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15780 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15781 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015782 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15785rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15786 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15787 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15788 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15789 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15790 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15791 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15792 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15795 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15796 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15797 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15798 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15799 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801 ACL derivatives :
15802 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 Example :
15805 listen tse-farm
15806 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15807 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15808 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15809 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15810 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15811 persist rdp-cookie
15812 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15813 # This is only useful makes sense if
15814 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15815 stick-table type string size 204800
15816 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15817 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15818 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15821 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15824rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15825 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15826 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15827 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15828 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 ACL derivatives :
15831 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015832
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015833req.ssl_alpn : string
15834 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15835 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15836 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15837 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15838 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15839 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015840 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015841
15842 Examples :
15843 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15844 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15845 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015846 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015847 default_backend bk_default
15848
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015849req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15850 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15851 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015852 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15853 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15854 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15855 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15856 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15859req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15860 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15861 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15862 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15863 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15864 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15865 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15866 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868req.ssl_sni : string
15869req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15870 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15871 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15872 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15873 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15874 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15875 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15876 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15877 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15878 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15879 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15880 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15881 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883 ACL derivatives :
15884 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886 Examples :
15887 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15888 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15889 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15890 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15891 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015892
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015893req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15894 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15895 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15896 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15897 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15898 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15899 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15900 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15901 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15902 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904req.ssl_ver : integer
15905req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15906 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15907 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15908 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15909 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15910 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15911 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15912 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015913 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 ACL derivatives :
15917 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015918
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015919res.len : integer
15920 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15921 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15922 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15923 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15924 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15925 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15926 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15927 content inspection.
15928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15930 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015931 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15932 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15933 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15934 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15937 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15938 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15939 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15940 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015943
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015944res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15945rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15946 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15947 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15948 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15949 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15950 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15951 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15952 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954wait_end : boolean
15955 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15956 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015957 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015958 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15959 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15962 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964 Examples :
15965 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15966 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15967 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15970 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15971 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15972 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15973 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15974 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15975 tcp-request content reject
15976
15977
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159787.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979--------------------------------------
15980
15981It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15982This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15983data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15984its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15985HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15986content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15987to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15988more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15989response are indexed.
15990
15991base : string
15992 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15993 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15994 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15995 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15996 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15997 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15998 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15999 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16000
16001 ACL derivatives :
16002 base : exact string match
16003 base_beg : prefix match
16004 base_dir : subdir match
16005 base_dom : domain match
16006 base_end : suffix match
16007 base_len : length match
16008 base_reg : regex match
16009 base_sub : substring match
16010
16011base32 : integer
16012 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16013 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16014 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016015 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16016 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16017 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018
16019base32+src : binary
16020 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16021 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16022 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16023 per-URL counters.
16024
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016025capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16026 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16027 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16028 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16029
16030capture.req.method : string
16031 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16032 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16033 because it's allocated.
16034
16035capture.req.uri : string
16036 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16037 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16038 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16039 allocated.
16040
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016041capture.req.ver : string
16042 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16043 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16044 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16045
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016046capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16047 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16048 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16049 The first entry is an index of 0.
16050 See also: "capture response header"
16051
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016052capture.res.ver : string
16053 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16054 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16055 persistent flag.
16056
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016057req.body : binary
16058 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16059 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16060 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16061 the first chunk is analyzed.
16062
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016063req.body_param([<name>) : string
16064 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16065 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16066 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16067 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16068 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16069 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16070 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16071 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16072 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16073 given.
16074
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016075req.body_len : integer
16076 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16077 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16078 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16079 "option http-buffer-request".
16080
16081req.body_size : integer
16082 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16083 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16084 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16085 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16086 "option http-buffer-request".
16087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088req.cook([<name>]) : string
16089cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16090 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16091 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16092 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16093 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16094 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16095 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16096 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16097 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16098
16099 ACL derivatives :
16100 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16101 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16102 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16103 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16104 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16105 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16106 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16107 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16110cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16111 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16112 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16115cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16116 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16117 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16118 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16119 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16122 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16123 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16124 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16125 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016126 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16128 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16129 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16130 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16133 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16134 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16135 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16136 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016137 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16140 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16141 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16142 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16143 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16144 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16145 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16146 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16147 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16150 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16151 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16152 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16153 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16156 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16157 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16158 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16159 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16160 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16161 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16162 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16163 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016164 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016166 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168 ACL derivatives :
16169 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16170 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16171 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16172 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16173 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16174 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16175 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16176 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16177
16178req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16179hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16180 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16181 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16182 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16183 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16184 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16185 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16186 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16187 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16188 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16189
16190req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16191hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16192 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16193 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16194 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16195 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16196 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016197 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16199 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16200
16201req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16202hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16203 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16204 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16205 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16206 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16207 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16208 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16209 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16210
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016211
16212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16214 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16215 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16216 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16217 basic auth is supported.
16218
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016219http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16220 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16221 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16222 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16223 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016224 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16225 basic auth is supported.
16226
16227 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016228 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16229 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16230 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16231 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016233http_auth_pass : string
16234 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16235 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16236 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16237
16238http_auth_type : string
16239 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16240 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16241 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16242
16243http_auth_user : string
16244 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16245 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16246 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016249 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16250 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016251 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16252 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254method : integer + string
16255 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16256 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16257 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16258 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16259 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16260 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16261 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 ACL derivatives :
16264 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 Example :
16267 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16268 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16269 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271path : string
16272 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16273 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16274 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16275 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16276 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016277 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280 ACL derivatives :
16281 path : exact string match
16282 path_beg : prefix match
16283 path_dir : subdir match
16284 path_dom : domain match
16285 path_end : suffix match
16286 path_len : length match
16287 path_reg : regex match
16288 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016289
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016290query : string
16291 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16292 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16293 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16294 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016295 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016296 which stops before the question mark.
16297
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016298req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16299 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16300 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16301 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16302 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016304req.ver : string
16305req_ver : string (deprecated)
16306 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16307 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16308 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 ACL derivatives :
16311 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313res.comp : boolean
16314 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16315 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16316 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318res.comp_algo : string
16319 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16320 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16321 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323res.cook([<name>]) : string
16324scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16325 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16326 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16327 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016329 ACL derivatives :
16330 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016332res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16333scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16334 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16335 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16336 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016338res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16339scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16340 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16341 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16342 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16345 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16346 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16347 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16348 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16349 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16350 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16351 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16352 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16353 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16356 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16357 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16358 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16359 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16360 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016362res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16363shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16364 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16365 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16366 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16367 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16368 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16369 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16370 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16371 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373 ACL derivatives :
16374 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16375 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16376 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16377 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16378 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16379 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16380 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16381 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16382
16383res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16384shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16385 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16386 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16387 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16388 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16389 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16392shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16393 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16394 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16395 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16396 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16397 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16398 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016399
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016400res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16401 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16402 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16403 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16404 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16407shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16409 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16410 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16411 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16412 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16413 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415res.ver : string
16416resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16417 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16418 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 ACL derivatives :
16421 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16424 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16425 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016426 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016427 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016429 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16430 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432status : integer
16433 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16434 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16435 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016436
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016437unique-id : string
16438 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16439 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16440 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16441 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16442 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16443 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016445url : string
16446 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16447 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16448 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16449 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16450 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16451 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16452 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454 ACL derivatives :
16455 url : exact string match
16456 url_beg : prefix match
16457 url_dir : subdir match
16458 url_dom : domain match
16459 url_end : suffix match
16460 url_len : length match
16461 url_reg : regex match
16462 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016464url_ip : ip
16465 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16466 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16467 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16468 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16469 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16470 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16471 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473url_port : integer
16474 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16475 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16476 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16477 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016478
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016479urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16480url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016481 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16482 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016483 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16484 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16485 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16486 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016487 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16488 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016489 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16490 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492 ACL derivatives :
16493 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16494 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16495 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16496 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16497 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16498 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16499 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16500 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016501
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503 Example :
16504 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16505 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16506 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16507 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016508
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016509urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16511 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16512 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016513
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016514url32 : integer
16515 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16516 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16517 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16518 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16519 is an unsigned integer.
16520
16521url32+src : binary
16522 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16523 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16524 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16525
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016526
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100165277.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16528---------------------------------------
16529
16530This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16531used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16532purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16533There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16534or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16535any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16536for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16537
16538internal.htx.data : integer
16539 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16540 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16541
16542internal.htx.free : integer
16543 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16544 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16545
16546internal.htx.free_data : integer
16547 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16548 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16549
16550internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16551 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16552 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16553 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16554
16555internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16556 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16557 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16558
16559internal.htx.size : integer
16560 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16561 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16562
16563internal.htx.used : integer
16564 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16565 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16566 direction.
16567
16568internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16569 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16570 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16571 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16572 of the special value :
16573 * head : The oldest inserted block
16574 * tail : The newest inserted block
16575 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16576
16577internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16578 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16579 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16580 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16581 integer or one of the special value :
16582 * head : The oldest inserted block
16583 * tail : The newest inserted block
16584 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16585
16586internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16587 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16588 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16589 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16590 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16591
16592 * head : The oldest inserted block
16593 * tail : The newest inserted block
16594 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16595
16596internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16597 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16598 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16599 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16600 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16601
16602 * head : The oldest inserted block
16603 * tail : The newest inserted block
16604 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16605
16606internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16607 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16608 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16609 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16610 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16611
16612 * head : The oldest inserted block
16613 * tail : The newest inserted block
16614 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16615
16616internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16617 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16618 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16619 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16620 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16621
16622 * head : The oldest inserted block
16623 * tail : The newest inserted block
16624 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16625
16626internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16627 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16628 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16629 it returns false.
16630
16631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166327.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016633---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016635Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16636every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016637order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016639ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16640---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016641FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016642HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016643HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16644HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016645HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16646HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16647HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16648HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16649LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016650METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016651METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016652METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16653METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16654METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16655METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016656METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016657METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016658RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016659REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016660TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016661WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16662---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016663
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166658. Logging
16666----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016668One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16669provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16670very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16671provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16672state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016673to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016674headers.
16675
16676In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16677about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16678send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16679
16680 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16681 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16682 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16683 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16684 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016685 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016686 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016687
16688The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16689allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16690as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16691while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16692real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16693delay.
16694
16695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166968.1. Log levels
16697---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016699TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016700source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016701HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16702in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16703track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16704syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16705about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016706
16707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167088.2. Log formats
16709----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016710
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016711HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016712and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16713slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16714options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016715
16716 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16717 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16718 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16719 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16720 extents.
16721
16722 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16723 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16724 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16725 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16726 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16727
16728 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16729 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16730 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16731 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16732 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16733
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016734 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16735 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16736 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16737 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16738
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016739 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16740
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016741Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16742specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16743field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16744servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16745always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16746identifier.
16747
16748Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16749 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16750 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16751 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16752 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16753
16754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167558.2.1. Default log format
16756-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016757
16758This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16759as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16760format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16761
16762 Example :
16763 listen www
16764 mode http
16765 log global
16766 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16767
16768 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16769 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16770 (www/HTTP)
16771
16772 Field Format Extract from the example above
16773 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16774 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16775 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16776 4 'to' to
16777 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16778 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16779
16780Detailed fields description :
16781 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16782 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16783 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16784 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16785 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16786 and processed the connection.
16787 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16788
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016789In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16790"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16791connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16792
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016793It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16794will eventually disappear.
16795
16796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167978.2.2. TCP log format
16798---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016799
16800The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16801is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16802information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16803counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16804emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16805environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16806the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16807sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016808specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16809not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16810fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16811marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016812
16813 Example :
16814 frontend fnt
16815 mode tcp
16816 option tcplog
16817 log global
16818 default_backend bck
16819
16820 backend bck
16821 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16822
16823 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16824 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16825 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16826
16827 Field Format Extract from the example above
16828 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16829 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16830 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16831 4 frontend_name fnt
16832 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16833 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16834 7 bytes_read* 212
16835 8 termination_state --
16836 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16837 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16838
16839Detailed fields description :
16840 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016841 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16842 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16843 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016844 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016845 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016846 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016847
16848 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016849 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16850 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16851 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016852
16853 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16854 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16855 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016856 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16857 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16858 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16859 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016860
16861 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16862 and processed the connection.
16863
16864 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16865 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16866 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16867 applications.
16868
16869 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16870 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16871 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16872 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16873 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16874
16875 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16876 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16877 See "Timers" below for more details.
16878
16879 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16880 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16881 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16882 "Timers" below for more details.
16883
16884 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016885 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016886 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16887 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16888 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16889 details.
16890
16891 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16892 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16893 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16894 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16895 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16896
16897 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16898 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16899 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16900 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16901 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16902 for more details.
16903
16904 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016905 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016906 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16907 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16908 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016909 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016910
16911 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16912 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16913 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16914 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16915 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16916 caused by a denial of service attack.
16917
16918 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16919 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16920 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16921 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16922 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16923 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16924 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16925 denial of service attack.
16926
16927 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16928 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16929 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16930 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16931 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16932 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16933 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16934 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16935 be processed than on other servers.
16936
16937 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16938 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16939 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16940 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16941 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16942 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16943 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16944 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16945 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16946 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16947 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16948 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16949 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16950
16951 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16952 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16953 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16954 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16955 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16956 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016957 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016958 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16959
16960 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16961 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16962 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16963 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16964 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16965 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016966 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016967 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16968 occurs.
16969
16970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169718.2.3. HTTP log format
16972----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016973
16974The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16975is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16976the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16977are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16978emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16979generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16980"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16981which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016982frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16983is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016984
16985Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16986slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16987with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16988
16989 Example :
16990 frontend http-in
16991 mode http
16992 option httplog
16993 log global
16994 default_backend bck
16995
16996 backend static
16997 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16998
16999 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17000 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17001 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017002 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003
17004 Field Format Extract from the example above
17005 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17006 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017007 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017008 4 frontend_name http-in
17009 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017010 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017011 7 status_code 200
17012 8 bytes_read* 2750
17013 9 captured_request_cookie -
17014 10 captured_response_cookie -
17015 11 termination_state ----
17016 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17017 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17018 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17019 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17020 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017021
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017022Detailed fields description :
17023 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017024 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17025 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17026 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017027 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017028 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017029 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017030
17031 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017032 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17033 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17034 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017036 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17037 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038
17039 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17040 and processed the connection.
17041
17042 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17043 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17044 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17045
17046 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17047 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17048 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17049 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17050 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17051 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17052
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017053 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17054 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17055 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017056 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017057 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17058 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017059 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17060 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017061
17062 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17063 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017064 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017065
17066 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17067 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017068 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17069 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017070
17071 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17072 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17073 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17074 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17075 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017076 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17077 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017078
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017079 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17080 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17081 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17082 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17083 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17084 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17085 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017086 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017087
17088 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17089 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17090 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17091
17092 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17093 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017094 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17096 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17097 overflowing.
17098
17099 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17100 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17101 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17102 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17103 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17104 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17105 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17106 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17107
17108 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17109 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17110 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17111 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17112 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17113 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17114 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17115 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17116
17117 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17118 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17119 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17120 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17121 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17122 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17123 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17124
17125 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017126 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017127 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17128 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17129 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017130 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017131 system.
17132
17133 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17134 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17135 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17136 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17137 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17138 caused by a denial of service attack.
17139
17140 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17141 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17142 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17143 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17144 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17145 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17146 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17147 denial of service attack.
17148
17149 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17150 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17151 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17152 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17153 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17154 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17155 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17156 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17157 processed than on other servers.
17158
17159 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17160 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17161 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17162 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17163 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17164 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17165 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17166 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17167 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17168 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17169 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17170 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17171 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17172
17173 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17174 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17175 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17176 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17177 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17178 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017179 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017180 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17181
17182 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17183 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17184 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17185 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17186 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17187 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017188 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017189 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17190 occurs.
17191
17192 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17193 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17194 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17195 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17196 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17197 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17198 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17199 cookies" below for more details.
17200
17201 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17202 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17203 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17204 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17205 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17206 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17207 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17208 and cookies" below for more details.
17209
17210 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17211 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17212 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17213 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17214 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17215 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17216 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17217 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17218
17219
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172208.2.4. Custom log format
17221------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017222
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017223The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017224mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017225
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017226HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017227Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17228separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17229prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17230
17231Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17232variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017233("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017234
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017235If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017236as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017237less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17238the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17239
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017240Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017241In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017242in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017243
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017244Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17245'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17246https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17247such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17248
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017249Flags are :
17250 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017251 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017252 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17253 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017254
17255 Example:
17256
17257 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17258 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17259
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017260 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17261
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017262At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17263
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017264 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17265 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017266
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017267the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017268
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017269 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17270 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17271 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017272
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017273and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17274
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017275 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17276 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017277
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017278Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17279
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017280 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017281 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017282 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17283 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17284 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017285 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17286 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17287 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017288 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017289 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17290 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017291 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017292 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17293 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017294 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017295 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017296 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017297 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017298 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017299 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017300 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017301 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17302 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17303 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17304 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17305 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017306 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017307 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17308 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017309 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017310 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17311 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017312 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17313 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17314 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017315 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017316 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17317 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017318 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017319 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17320 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17321 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017322 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017323 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017324 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17325 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17326 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17327 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017328 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017329 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017330 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017331 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017332 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017333 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017334 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17335 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17336 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017337 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017338 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17339 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017340 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017341 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17342 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017343 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017344 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017345 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017346 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017347
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017348 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017349
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017350
173518.2.5. Error log format
17352-----------------------
17353
17354When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17355protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17356By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17357"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017358will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017359logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17360
17361The format looks like this :
17362
17363 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17364 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17365 Connection error during SSL handshake
17366
17367 Field Format Extract from the example above
17368 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17369 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17370 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17371 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17372 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17373
17374These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17375failures.
17376
17377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173788.3. Advanced logging options
17379-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017380
17381Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17382just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17383options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17384for more information about their usage.
17385
17386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17388------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017389
17390It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17391haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17392commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17393monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17394ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17395
17396 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17397 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17398 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17399 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17400
17401 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17402 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17403 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017404 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017405 such as other load-balancers.
17406
17407 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17408 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17409 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17410
17411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174128.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17413----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414
17415The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17416what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17417or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017418"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017419just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17420log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17421after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17422is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17423with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17424with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17425
17426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174278.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17428------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017429
17430Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17431for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17432"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17433retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17434raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17435a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17436file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17437you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17438"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17439
17440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174418.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17442--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017443
17444Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17445multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17446them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17447"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17448logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17449error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17450and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17451too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17452useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17453alternative.
17454
17455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174568.4. Timing events
17457------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017458
17459Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17460reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17461the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17462frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017463mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17464addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17465
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017466Timings events in HTTP mode:
17467
17468 first request 2nd request
17469 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17470 t tr t tr ...
17471 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17472 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17473 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17474 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17475 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17476
17477Timings events in TCP mode:
17478
17479 TCP session
17480 |<----------------->|
17481 t t
17482 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17483 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17484 |<------ Tt ------->|
17485
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017486 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017487 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017488 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17489 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17490 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017491 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017492 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17493 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17494 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17495 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017496
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017497 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17498 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17499 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017500 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17501 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17502 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17503 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17504 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17505 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017506
17507 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17508 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17509 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17510 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17511 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17512 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17513 request typed by hand during a test.
17514
17515 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17516 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017517 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017518 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17519 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17520 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17521 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522
17523 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17524 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17525 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17526 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17527 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17528
17529 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17530 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17531 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17532 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17533 connection never established.
17534
17535 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17536 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17537 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17538 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17539 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17540 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17541 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17542 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17543 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17544 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17545 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17546
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017547 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17548 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17549 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17550 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17551 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17552 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17553
17554 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17555
17556 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17557 "Ta" can never be negative.
17558
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017559 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17560 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017561 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17562 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017563 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017565 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017566
17567 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017568 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17569 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017570
17571These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17572protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17573that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017574due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17575"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17576that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017577
17578Most common cases :
17579
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017580 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17581 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17582 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17583 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17584 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17585 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17586 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17587 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17588 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17589 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17590 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017591 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017592
17593 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17594 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17595 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17596 of ms on remote networks.
17597
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017598 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17599 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17600 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017601
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017602 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17603 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17604 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17605 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17606 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17607 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17608 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17609 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17610 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017611
17612Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17613
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017614 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017615 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017616 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017617
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017618 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017619 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17620 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17621
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017622 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017623 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17624 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17625 flags.
17626
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017627 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17628 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017629 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17630 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17631 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17632 the client connection was maintained open.
17633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017634 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017635 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017636 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017637 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17638
17639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176408.5. Session state at disconnection
17641-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642
17643TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17644"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
176452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17646each of which has a special meaning :
17647
17648 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17649 session to terminate :
17650
17651 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17652
17653 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17654 server explicitly refused it.
17655
17656 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17657 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17658 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17659 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017660 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017661
17662 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17663 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017664
17665 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17666 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17667 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17668 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17669 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17670
17671 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17672 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17673 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17674 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17675 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17676
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017677 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17678 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17679
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017680 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17681 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17682 backup connections when going up.
17683
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017684 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17685
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017686 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17687 send or receive data.
17688
17689 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17690 send or receive data.
17691
17692 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17693 with nothing left in the buffers.
17694
17695 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17696
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017697 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017698 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17699
17700 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17701 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17702 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17703 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17704 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17705
17706 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17707 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17708
17709 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17710 server (HTTP only).
17711
17712 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17713
17714 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17715 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17716 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17717
17718 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17719 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17720 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17721
17722 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17723
17724 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17725 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17726
17727 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17728 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17729 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17730
17731 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17732 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017733 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17734 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017735
17736 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17737 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17738 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17739 another server.
17740
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017741 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017742 server.
17743
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017744 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17745 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17746 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17747 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17748
17749 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17750 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17751 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17752 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17753
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017754 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17755 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17756 "use-server" rule).
17757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017758 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17759
17760 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17761 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17762
17763 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17764
17765 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17766 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17767 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17768
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017769 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17770 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017771 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017772 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17773 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17774
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017775 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17776
17777 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17778 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17779
17780 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17781
17782 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17783
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017784The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17785was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017786helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17787starvation, attacks, etc...
17788
17789The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17790alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17791easier finding and understanding.
17792
17793 Flags Reason
17794
17795 -- Normal termination.
17796
17797 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17798 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17799 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17800 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17801
17802 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17803 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17804 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17805 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17806 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17807 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017808
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017809 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17810 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017811 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017812
17813 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17814 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17815 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17816
17817 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17818 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17819 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17820 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17821 the server takes too long to respond.
17822
17823 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17824 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17825 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17826 long a time to respond.
17827
17828 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17829 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17830 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17831 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017832 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17833 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017834
17835 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17836 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17837 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17838 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17839 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017840 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017841 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17842 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17843 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17844 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17845 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17846 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17847 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17848 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017849 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017850 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17851 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17852 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017853
17854 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17855 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017856 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17857 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17858 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17859 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017860
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017861 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17862 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017864 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017865 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17866 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017867 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017868 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17869 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17870
17871 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17872 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17873 503 or 504 here.
17874
17875 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17876 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17877 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17878 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17879 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17880
17881 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17882 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017883 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017884 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17885 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17886
17887 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17888 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17889 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17890 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17891 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17892 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17893 between haproxy and the server.
17894
17895 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17896 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17897 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17898 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17899 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17900 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17901 solution is to fix the application.
17902
17903 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17904 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17905 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17906 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17907 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17908 external attacks.
17909
17910 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17911 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017912 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017913 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17914 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17915
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017916 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17917 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17918 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017919 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017920 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017921
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017922 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17923 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17924 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17925 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017926 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17927 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17928 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17929 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17930 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017931
17932 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17933 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17934 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17935 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17936
17937 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17938 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17939 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17940 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17941
17942 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17943 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17944 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17945 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17946
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017947The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17948persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17949important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17950re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17951
17952 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17953
17954 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17955 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17956 set on a GET request.
17957
17958 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17959 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017960 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017961 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17962
17963 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17964 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17965 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17966
17967 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17968 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17969 already got a cookie.
17970
17971 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17972 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17973 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17974 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17975 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17976
17977 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17978 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17979 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17980
17981 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17982 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17983 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17984
17985 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17986 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17987
17988 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17989 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17990 then advertised in the response.
17991
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179938.6. Non-printable characters
17994-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017995
17996In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17997consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17998converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17999prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18000being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18001escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18002is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18003'}' when logging headers.
18004
18005Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18006issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18007containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18008
18009Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18010the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18011performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18012
18013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18015---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018016
18017Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18018achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018019section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18021the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18022the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018023locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018024not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18025user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18026a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18027wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18028
18029 Examples :
18030 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18031 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18032
18033 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18034 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18035
18036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180378.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18038---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018039
18040Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18041proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18042the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18043server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18044
18045Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18046response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018047section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018048
18049It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018050time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18051appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018052are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18053and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18054follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18055request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18056in the logs.
18057
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018058As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18059frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18060an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18061
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018062 Example :
18063 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18064 listen proxy-out
18065 mode http
18066 option httplog
18067 option logasap
18068 log global
18069 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18070
18071 # log the name of the virtual server
18072 capture request header Host len 20
18073
18074 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18075 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18076
18077 # log the beginning of the referrer
18078 capture request header Referer len 20
18079
18080 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18081 capture response header Server len 20
18082
18083 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18084 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018086 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18088
18089 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18090 capture response header Via len 20
18091
18092 # log the URL location during a redirection
18093 capture response header Location len 20
18094
18095 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18096 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18097 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18098 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18099 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18100
18101 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18102 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18103 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18104 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018105 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018106
18107 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18108 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18109 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18110 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18111 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018112 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018113
18114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181158.9. Examples of logs
18116---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117
18118These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18119them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18120reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18121
18122 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18123 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18124 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18125
18126 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18127 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18128
18129 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18130 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18131 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18132
18133 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18134 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18135
18136 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18137 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18138 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18139
18140 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018141 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018142 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18143 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18144
18145 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18146 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18147 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18148
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018149 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18150 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18151 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18152 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18153 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18154 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018155
18156 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018157 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018158
18159 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18160 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18161 Nothing was sent to any server.
18162
18163 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18164 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18165
18166 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18167 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018168 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018169 send a 408 return code to the client.
18170
18171 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18172 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18173
18174 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18175 5 seconds ("c----").
18176
18177 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18178 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018179 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180
18181 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018182 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018183 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18184 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18185 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18186 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18187 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018188
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018189
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181909. Supported filters
18191--------------------
18192
18193Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18194accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18195unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18196
18197See also : "filter"
18198
181999.1. Trace
18200----------
18201
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018202filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018203
18204 Arguments:
18205 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18206 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18207
18208 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18209 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18210 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18211 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18212
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018213 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018214 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18215 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18216 amount of the parsed data.
18217
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018218 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018219
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018220This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18221callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18222information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18223filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18224
18225Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18226tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18227a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18228
18229
182309.2. HTTP compression
18231---------------------
18232
18233filter compression
18234
18235The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18236keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018237when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18238fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18239done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18240explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18241filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18242listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18243order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018244
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018245See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18246 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018247
18248
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200182499.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18250--------------------------------------------
18251
18252filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18253
18254 Arguments :
18255
18256 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18257 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18258 parsed.
18259
18260 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18261 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18262 part must be placed in its own scope.
18263
18264The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18265external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018266streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018267exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18268also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18269
18270SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18271the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18272
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018273For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018274"doc/SPOE.txt".
18275
18276Important note:
18277 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18278 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18279
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182809.4. Cache
18281----------
18282
18283filter cache <name>
18284
18285 Arguments :
18286
18287 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18288
18289The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18290"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018291cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018292other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18293case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18294is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18295filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018296listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18297order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018298
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018299See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18300 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18301
18302
183039.5. Fcgi-app
18304-------------
18305
18306filter fcg-app <name>
18307
18308 Arguments :
18309
18310 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18311
18312The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18313request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18314reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18315used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18316implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18317used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18318fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18319used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18320order.
18321
18322See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18323 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18324
18325
1832610. FastCGI applications
18327-------------------------
18328
18329HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18330feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18331the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18332FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18333servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18334FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18335backend.
18336
18337HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18338application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18339connection.
18340
1834110.1. Setup
18342-----------
18343
1834410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18345--------------------------
18346
18347fcgi-app <name>
18348 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18349 document root must be defined.
18350
18351acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18352 Declare or complete an access list.
18353
18354 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18355 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18356 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18357 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18358 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18359
18360docroot <path>
18361 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18362 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18363 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18364
18365index <script-name>
18366 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18367 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18368 is an optional setting.
18369
18370 Example :
18371 index index.php
18372
18373log-stderr global
18374log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18375 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18376 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18377
18378 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18379 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18380
18381pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18382 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18383 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18384 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18385
18386 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18387 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18388 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18389 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18390
18391 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18392 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18393
18394path-info <regex>
18395 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18396 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18397 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18398 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18399 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18400
18401 Example :
18402 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18403
18404option get-values
18405no option get-values
18406 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18407
18408 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18409 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18410
18411 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18412 application will accept.
18413
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018414 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18415 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018416
18417 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18418 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18419 option is disabled.
18420
18421 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18422 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18423 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18424 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18425 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18426 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18427
18428option keep-conn
18429no option keep-conn
18430 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18431 sending a response.
18432
18433 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18434 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18435
18436option max-reqs <reqs>
18437 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18438 accept.
18439
18440 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18441 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18442 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18443 to 1.
18444
18445option mpxs-conns
18446no option mpxs-conns
18447 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18448
18449 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18450 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18451
18452set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18453 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18454 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18455 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18456 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18457
18458 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18459 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18460 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18461
18462 Example :
18463 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18464 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18465
18466 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18467
18468
1846910.1.2. Proxy section
18470---------------------
18471
18472use-fcgi-app <name>
18473 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18474
18475 Arguments :
18476 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18477
18478 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18479 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18480 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18481 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18482 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18483
18484 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18485 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18486 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18487 application are evaluated.
18488
18489
1849010.1.3. Example
18491---------------
18492
18493 frontend front-http
18494 mode http
18495 bind *:80
18496 bind *:
18497
18498 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18499 default_backend back-static
18500
18501 backend back-static
18502 mode http
18503 server www A.B.C.D:80
18504
18505 backend back-dynamic
18506 mode http
18507 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18508 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18509
18510 fcgi-app php-fpm
18511 log-stderr global
18512 option keep-conn
18513
18514 docroot /var/www/my-app
18515 index index.php
18516 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18517
18518
1851910.2. Default parameters
18520------------------------
18521
18522A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18523the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18524scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18525applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18526
18527 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18528 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18529 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18530 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18531 | | |
18532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18533 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18534 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18535 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18536 | | application. |
18537 | | |
18538 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18539 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18540 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18541 | | |
18542 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18543 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18544 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18545 | | the application's configuration. |
18546 | | |
18547 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18548 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18549 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18550 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18551 | | |
18552 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18553 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18554 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18555 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18556 | | be defined. |
18557 | | |
18558 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18559 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18560 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18561 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18562 | | is not set too. |
18563 | | |
18564 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18565 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18566 | | set. |
18567 | | |
18568 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18569 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18570 | | the request. |
18571 | | |
18572 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18573 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18574 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18575 | | |
18576 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18577 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18578 | | script to process the request. |
18579 | | |
18580 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18581 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18582 | | |
18583 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18584 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18585 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18586 | | |
18587 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18588 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18589 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18590 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18591 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18592 | | |
18593 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18594 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18595 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18596 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18597 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18598 | | side. |
18599 | | |
18600 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18601 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18602 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18603 | | connected to. |
18604 | | |
18605 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18606 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18607 | | |
18608 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18609 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18610 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18611 | | |
18612 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18613
18614
1861510.3. Limitations
18616------------------
18617
18618The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18619way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18620during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18621establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18622application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18623or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18624message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18625these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18626and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18627
18628Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18629request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18630requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18631
18632About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18633into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18634fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18635"http-request" ones.
18636
18637Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18638FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18639processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18640must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18641here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018643/*
18644 * Local variables:
18645 * fill-column: 79
18646 * End:
18647 */